1st Engrossment - 83rd Legislature (2003 - 2004) Posted on 12/15/2009 12:00am
1.1 A bill for an act 1.2 relating to education; providing for family and early 1.3 childhood and kindergarten through grade 12 education, 1.4 including general education, special programs, 1.5 education reform, facilities and technology, state 1.6 agencies, repeal of profile of learning, and statewide 1.7 accountability; providing for rulemaking; 1.8 appropriating money; amending Minnesota Statutes 2002, 1.9 sections 13.485, by adding a subdivision; 120A.05, 1.10 subdivision 11; 120A.24, subdivision 4; 120A.41; 1.11 120B.02; 120B.30, subdivision 1; 120B.35, by adding a 1.12 subdivision; 121A.21; 121A.23; 121A.41, subdivision 1.13 10; 121A.55; 121A.61, subdivision 3; 121A.64; 122A.09, 1.14 subdivision 4; 122A.18, subdivision 7a; 122A.22; 1.15 122A.40, subdivision 5; 122A.413; 122A.46, subdivision 1.16 9; 123B.14, subdivision 1; 123B.57, subdivision 2; 1.17 123B.59, subdivision 2; 123B.62; 123B.71, subdivisions 1.18 4, 9; 123B.77, subdivision 3; 123B.88, subdivision 2; 1.19 123B.90, subdivisions 2, 3; 123B.91, subdivision 1; 1.20 124D.09, subdivision 20; 124D.10, subdivisions 2a, 3, 1.21 4, 16, 20; 124D.13, subdivisions 4, 8; 124D.15, 1.22 subdivision 7; 124D.16, subdivision 1; 125A.023, 1.23 subdivision 3; 125A.03; 125A.28; 125A.30; 128C.02, 1.24 subdivision 1; 128C.05, by adding a subdivision; 1.25 169.28, subdivision 1; 169.4503, subdivision 4; 1.26 169.454, subdivisions 2, 6; 171.321, subdivision 5; 1.27 205A.07, by adding a subdivision; 354.094, subdivision 1.28 1; 574.26, subdivision 2; 611A.78, subdivision 1; 1.29 proposing coding for new law in Minnesota Statutes, 1.30 chapters 120B; 122A; 123B; 124D; 125A; 125B; repealing 1.31 Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 15.014, subdivision 1.32 3; 119A.08; 119A.51; 120B.031; 122A.414; 122A.415; 1.33 123B.90, subdivision 1; 124D.65, subdivision 4; 1.34 124D.93; 125A.09; 125A.47; 126C.125; 128C.01, 1.35 subdivision 5; 128C.02, subdivision 8; 128C.13; 1.36 144.401, subdivision 5; 169.441, subdivision 4; 1.37 239.004; Minnesota Rules, parts 3501.0300; 3501.0310; 1.38 3501.0320; 3501.0330; 3501.0340; 3501.0350; 3501.0370; 1.39 3501.0380; 3501.0390; 3501.0400; 3501.0410; 3501.0420; 1.40 3501.0440; 3501.0441; 3501.0442; 3501.0443; 3501.0444; 1.41 3501.0445; 3501.0446; 3501.0447; 3501.0448; 3501.0449; 1.42 3501.0450; 3501.0460; 3501.0461; 3501.0462; 3501.0463; 1.43 3501.0464; 3501.0465; 3501.0466; 3501.0467; 3501.0468; 1.44 3501.0469. 1.45 BE IT ENACTED BY THE LEGISLATURE OF THE STATE OF MINNESOTA: 2.1 ARTICLE 1 2.2 GENERAL EDUCATION 2.3 Section 1. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.77, 2.4 subdivision 3, is amended to read: 2.5 Subd. 3. [STATEMENT FOR COMPARISON AND CORRECTION.] By 2.6 October 1 of the calendar year for those districts conducting a 2.7 school district election on the first Tuesday after the first 2.8 Monday in November in the same calendar year under section 2.9 123B.62, 123B.63, 126C.17, 126C.69, or 475.58, or by November 30 2.10 of the calendar year of the submission of the unaudited 2.11 financial data for all other districts, the district must 2.12 provide to the commissioner audited financial data for the 2.13 preceding fiscal year. The audit must be conducted in 2.14 compliance with generally accepted governmental auditing 2.15 standards, the federal Single Audit Act, and the Minnesota legal 2.16 compliance guide issued by the office of the state auditor. An 2.17 audited financial statement prepared in a form which will allow 2.18 comparison with and correction of material differences in the 2.19 unaudited financial data shall be submitted to the commissioner 2.20 and the state auditor by December 31. The audited financial 2.21 statement must also provide a statement of assurance pertaining 2.22 to uniform financial accounting and reporting standards 2.23 compliance and a copy of the management letter submitted to the 2.24 district by the school district's auditor. 2.25 Sec. 2. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.88, 2.26 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 2.27 Subd. 2. [VOLUNTARY SURRENDER OF TRANSPORTATION 2.28 PRIVILEGES.] The parent or guardian of asecondarystudent may 2.29 voluntarily surrender thesecondarystudent's to and from school 2.30 transportation privileges granted under subdivision 1. 2.31 Sec. 3. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.09, 2.32 subdivision 20, is amended to read: 2.33 Subd. 20. [TEXTBOOKS; MATERIALS.] All textbooks and 2.34 equipment provided to a pupil, and paid for under subdivision 2.35 13, are the property of the pupil'sschool district of residence2.36 postsecondary institution. Each pupil is required to return all 3.1 textbooks and equipment to thedistrictpostsecondary 3.2 institution after the course has ended. 3.3 Sec. 4. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.10, 3.4 subdivision 16, is amended to read: 3.5 Subd. 16. [TRANSPORTATION.] (a) By July 1 of each year, a 3.6 charter school must notify the district in which the school is 3.7 located and the department of children, families, and learning 3.8 if it will provide transportation for pupils enrolled in the 3.9 school for the fiscal year. 3.10 (b) If a charter school elects to provide transportation 3.11 for pupils, the transportation must be provided by the charter 3.12 school within the district in which the charter school is 3.13 located. The state must pay transportation aid to the charter 3.14 school according to section 124D.11, subdivision 2. 3.15 For pupils who reside outside the district in which the 3.16 charter school is located, the charter school is not required to 3.17 provide or pay for transportation between the pupil's residence 3.18 and the border of the district in which the charter school is 3.19 located. A parent may be reimbursed by the charter school for 3.20 costs of transportation from the pupil's residence to the border 3.21 of the district in which the charter school is located if the 3.22 pupil is from a family whose income is at or below the poverty 3.23 level, as determined by the federal government. The 3.24 reimbursement may not exceed the pupil's actual cost of 3.25 transportation or 15 cents per mile traveled, whichever is 3.26 less. Reimbursement may not be paid for more than 250 miles per 3.27 week. 3.28 At the time a pupil enrolls in a charter school, the 3.29 charter school must provide the parent or guardian with 3.30 information regarding the transportation. 3.31 (c) If a charter school does not elect to provide 3.32 transportation, transportation for pupils enrolled at the school 3.33 must be provided by the district in which the school is located, 3.34 according to sections 123B.88, subdivision 6, and 124D.03, 3.35 subdivision 8, for a pupil residing in the same district in 3.36 which the charter school is located. Transportation may be 4.1 provided by the district in which the school is located, 4.2 according to sections 123B.88, subdivision 6, and 124D.03, 4.3 subdivision 8, for a pupil residing in a different district. If 4.4 the district provides the transportation, the scheduling of 4.5 routes, manner and method of transportation, control and 4.6 discipline of the pupils, and any other matter relating to the 4.7 transportation of pupils under this paragraph shall be within 4.8 the sole discretion, control, and management of the district. 4.9 Sec. 5. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 205A.07, is 4.10 amended by adding a subdivision to read: 4.11 Subd. 3a. [NOTICE TO COMMISSIONER OF CHILDREN, FAMILIES, 4.12 AND LEARNING.] At least 49 days prior to every school district 4.13 election, under section 123B.62, 123B.63, 126C.17, 126C.69, or 4.14 475.58, the school district clerk shall provide a written notice 4.15 to the commissioner of children, families, and learning. The 4.16 notice must include the date of the election and the title and 4.17 language for each ballot question to be voted on at the 4.18 election. The certified vote totals for each ballot question 4.19 shall be provided in a written notice to the commissioner in a 4.20 timely manner. 4.21 ARTICLE 2 4.22 EDUCATIONAL EXCELLENCE AND OTHER POLICY 4.23 Section 1. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 13.485, is 4.24 amended by adding a subdivision to read: 4.25 Subd. 5. [SCHOOL DISTRICT CONTRACTS.] Financial statements 4.26 submitted by certain contractors with school districts are 4.27 classified under section 574.26. 4.28 Sec. 2. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120A.05, 4.29 subdivision 11, is amended to read: 4.30 Subd. 11. [MIDDLE SCHOOL.] "Middle school" means any 4.31 school other than a secondary school giving an approved course 4.32 of study in a minimum ofthreetwo consecutive grades above 4th 4.33 but below 10th with building, equipment, courses of study, class 4.34 schedules, enrollment, and staff meeting the standards 4.35 established by the commissioner of children, families, and 4.36 learning. 5.1 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 5.2 2003-2004 school year and later. 5.3 Sec. 3. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120A.24, 5.4 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 5.5 Subd. 4. [REPORTS TO THE STATE.] A superintendent must 5.6 make an annual report to the commissioner of children, families, 5.7 and learning. The report must include the following information: 5.8 (1) the number of children residing in the district 5.9 attending nonpublic schools or receiving instruction from 5.10 persons or institutions other than a public school; 5.11 (2) the number of children in clause (1) who are in 5.12 compliance with section 120A.22 and this section; and 5.13 (3) thenames, ages, and addressesnumber of childrenwhom5.14 in clause (1) who the superintendent has determined are not in 5.15 compliance with section 120A.22 and this section. 5.16 Sec. 4. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120A.41, is 5.17 amended to read: 5.18 120A.41 [LENGTH OF SCHOOL YEAR; DAYS OF INSTRUCTION.] 5.19 A school board's annual school calendar must include at 5.20 leastthree additional days of student instruction or staff5.21development training related to implementing section 120B.031,5.22subdivision 1, paragraph (f), beyondthe number of days of 5.23 student instruction the board formally adopted as its school 5.24 calendar at the beginning of the 1996-1997 school year. 5.25 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 5.26 2003-2004 school year. 5.27 Sec. 5. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120B.35, is 5.28 amended by adding a subdivision to read: 5.29 Subd. 5. [IMPROVING GRADUATION RATES FOR STUDENTS WITH 5.30 EMOTIONAL OR BEHAVIORAL DISORDERS.] (a) A district must develop 5.31 strategies in conjunction with parents of students with 5.32 emotional or behavioral disorders and the county board 5.33 responsible for implementing sections 245.487 to 245.4888 to 5.34 keep students with emotional or behavioral disorders in school, 5.35 when the district has a drop-out rate for students with an 5.36 emotional or behavioral disorder in grades 9 through 12 6.1 exceeding 25 percent. 6.2 (b) A district must develop a plan in conjunction with 6.3 parents of students with emotional or behavioral disorders and 6.4 the local mental health authority to increase the graduation 6.5 rates of students with emotional or behavioral disorders. A 6.6 district with a drop-out rate for children with an emotional or 6.7 behavioral disturbance in grades 9 through 12 that is in the top 6.8 25 percent of all districts shall submit a plan for review and 6.9 oversight to the commissioner. 6.10 Sec. 6. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.23, is 6.11 amended to read: 6.12 121A.23 [PROGRAMS TO PREVENT AND REDUCE THE RISKS OF 6.13 SEXUALLY TRANSMITTED INFECTIONSAND DISEASES.] 6.14 Subdivision 1. [SEXUALLY TRANSMITTEDDISEASESINFECTION 6.15 PROGRAM.] The commissioner of children, families, and learning, 6.16 in consultation with the commissioner of health, shall assist 6.17 districts in developing and implementing a program to prevent 6.18 and reduce the risk of sexually transmitted infectionsand6.19diseases, including, but notexclusivelimited to, human 6.20 immune deficiency virus and human papilloma virus. Each 6.21 district must have a program that includes at least: 6.22 (1) planning materials, guidelines, and other technically 6.23 accurate and updated information; 6.24 (2) a comprehensive, technically accurate, and updated 6.25 curriculum thatincludesemphasizes, but is not limited to, 6.26 helping students to abstain from sexual activityuntil marriage; 6.27 (3) cooperation and coordination among districts and SCs; 6.28 (4) a targeting of adolescents, especially those who may be 6.29 at high risk of contracting sexually transmitted infectionsand6.30diseases, for prevention efforts; 6.31 (5) involvement of parents and other community members; 6.32 (6) in-service training for appropriate district staff and 6.33 school board members; 6.34 (7) collaboration with state agencies and organizations 6.35 having a sexually transmitted infectionand diseaseprevention 6.36 or sexually transmitted infectionand diseaserisk reduction 7.1 program; 7.2 (8) collaboration with local community health services, 7.3 agencies and organizations having a sexually transmitted 7.4 infectionand diseaseprevention or sexually transmitted 7.5 infectionand diseaserisk reduction program; and 7.6 (9) participation by state and local student organizations. 7.7The department may provide assistance at a neutral site to7.8a nonpublic school participating in a district's program.7.9District programs must not conflict with the health and wellness7.10curriculum developed under Laws 1987, chapter 398, article 5,7.11section 2, subdivision 7.7.12If a district fails to develop and implement a program to7.13prevent and reduce the risk of sexually transmitted infection7.14and disease, the department must assist the service cooperative7.15in the region serving that district to develop or implement the7.16program.7.17 Subd. 2. [FUNDING SOURCES.] Districts may accept funds for 7.18 sexually transmitted infectionand diseaseprevention programs 7.19 developed and implemented under this section from public and 7.20 private sources including public health funds and foundations, 7.21 department professional development funds, federal block grants 7.22 or other federal or state grants. 7.23 Sec. 7. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.55, is 7.24 amended to read: 7.25 121A.55 [POLICIES TO BE ESTABLISHED.] 7.26 (a) The commissioner of children, families, and learning 7.27 shall promulgate guidelines to assist each school board. Each 7.28 school board shall establish uniform criteria for dismissal and 7.29 adopt written policies and rules to effectuate the purposes of 7.30 sections 121A.40 to 121A.56. The policies shall emphasize 7.31 preventing dismissals through early detection of problems and 7.32 shall be designed to address students' inappropriate behavior 7.33 from recurring. The policies shall recognize the continuing 7.34 responsibility of the school for the education of the pupil 7.35 during the dismissal period. The alternative educational 7.36 services, if the pupil wishes to take advantage of them, must be 8.1 adequate to allow the pupil to make progress towards meeting the 8.2 graduation standards adopted under section 120B.02 and help 8.3 prepare the pupil for readmission. 8.4 (b) An area learning center under section 123A.05 may not 8.5 prohibit an expelled or excluded pupil from enrolling solely 8.6 because a district expelled or excluded the pupil. The board of 8.7 the area learning center may use the provisions of the Pupil 8.8 Fair Dismissal Act to exclude a pupil or to require an admission 8.9 plan. 8.10 (c) The commissioner shall actively encourage and assist 8.11 school districts to cooperatively establish alternative 8.12 educational services within school buildings or at alternative 8.13 program sites that offer instruction to pupils who are dismissed 8.14 from school for willfully engaging in dangerous, disruptive, or 8.15 violent behavior, including for possessing a firearm in a school 8.16 zone. 8.17 (d) Each school district shall develop a policy and report 8.18 it to the commissioner on the appropriate use of peace officers 8.19 and crisis teams to remove students who have an individualized 8.20 education plan from school grounds. 8.21 Sec. 8. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.61, 8.22 subdivision 3, is amended to read: 8.23 Subd. 3. [POLICY COMPONENTS.] The policy must include at 8.24 least the following components: 8.25 (a) rules governing student conduct and procedures for 8.26 informing students of the rules; 8.27 (b) the grounds for removal of a student from a class; 8.28 (c) the authority of the classroom teacher to remove 8.29 students from the classroom pursuant to procedures and rules 8.30 established in the district's policy; 8.31 (d) the procedures for removal of a student from a class by 8.32 a teacher, school administrator, or other school district 8.33 employee; 8.34 (e) the period of time for which a student may be removed 8.35 from a class, which may not exceed five class periods for a 8.36 violation of a rule of conduct; 9.1 (f) provisions relating to the responsibility for and 9.2 custody of a student removed from a class; 9.3 (g) the procedures for return of a student to the specified 9.4 class from which the student has been removed; 9.5 (h) the procedures for notifying a student and the 9.6 student's parents or guardian of violations of the rules of 9.7 conduct and of resulting disciplinary actions; 9.8 (i) any procedures determined appropriate for encouraging 9.9 early involvement of parents or guardians in attempts to improve 9.10 a student's behavior; 9.11 (j) any procedures determined appropriate for encouraging 9.12 early detection of behavioral problems; 9.13 (k) any procedures determined appropriate for referring a 9.14 student in need of special education services to those services; 9.15 (1) the procedures for consideration of whether there is a 9.16 need for a further assessment or of whether there is a need for 9.17 a review of the adequacy of a current individual education plan 9.18 of a student with a disability who is removed from class; 9.19 (m) procedures for detecting and addressing chemical abuse 9.20 problems of a student while on the school premises; 9.21 (n) the minimum consequences for violations of the code of 9.22 conduct; 9.23 (o) procedures for immediate and appropriate interventions 9.24 tied to violations of the code;and9.25 (p) a provision that states that a teacher, school 9.26 employee, school bus driver, or other agent of a district may 9.27 use reasonable force in compliance with section 121A.582 and 9.28 other laws; and 9.29 (q) an agreement regarding procedures to coordinate crisis 9.30 services to the extent funds are available with the county board 9.31 responsible for implementing sections 245.487 to 245.4888 for 9.32 students with a serious emotional disturbance or other students 9.33 who have an individualized education plan whose behavior may be 9.34 addressed by crisis intervention. 9.35 Sec. 9. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.64, is 9.36 amended to read: 10.1 121A.64 [NOTIFICATION; TEACHERS' LEGITIMATE EDUCATIONAL 10.2 INTEREST.] 10.3 (a) A classroom teacher has a legitimate educational 10.4 interest in knowing which students placed in the teacher's 10.5 classroom have a history of violent behavior and must be 10.6 notified before such students are placed in the teacher's 10.7 classroom. 10.8 (b) Representatives of the school board and the exclusive 10.9 representative of the teachers shall discuss issues related to 10.10notification prior to placementthe model policy on student 10.11 records adopted under Laws 1999, chapter 241, article 9, section 10.12 50, and any modifications adopted under this act for notifying 10.13 classroom teachers and other school district employees having a 10.14 legitimate educational interest in knowing about students with a 10.15 history of violent behavior placed in classroomsof students10.16with histories of violent behavior and any. The representatives 10.17 of the school board and the exclusive representative of the 10.18 teachers also may discuss the need for intervention services or 10.19 conflict resolution or training for staffin these casesrelated 10.20 to placing students with a history of violent behavior in 10.21 teachers' classrooms. 10.22 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 10.23 2003-2004 school year and later. 10.24 Sec. 10. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.09, 10.25 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 10.26 Subd. 4. [LICENSE AND RULES.] (a) The board must adopt 10.27 rules to license public school teachers and interns subject to 10.28 chapter 14. 10.29 (b) The board must adopt rules requiring a person to 10.30 successfully complete a skills examination in reading, writing, 10.31 and mathematics as a requirement for initial teacher licensure. 10.32 Such rules must require college and universities offering a 10.33 board approved teacher preparation program to provide remedial 10.34 assistance to persons who did not achieve a qualifying score on 10.35 the skills examination, including those for whom English is a 10.36 second language. 11.1 (c) The board must adopt rules to approve teacher 11.2 preparation programs. The board, upon the request of a 11.3 post-secondary student preparing for teacher licensure or a 11.4 licensed graduate of a teacher preparation program, shall assist 11.5 in resolving a dispute between the person and a post-secondary 11.6 institution providing a teacher preparation program when the 11.7 dispute involves an institution's recommendation for licensure 11.8 affecting the person or the person's credentials. At the 11.9 board's discretion, assistance may include the application of 11.10 chapter 14. 11.11 (d) The board must provide the leadership and shall adopt 11.12 rules for the redesign of teacher education programs to 11.13 implement a research based, results-oriented curriculum that 11.14 focuses on the skills teachers need in order to be effective. 11.15 The board shall implement new systems of teacher preparation 11.16 program evaluation to assure program effectiveness based on 11.17 proficiency of graduates in demonstrating attainment of program 11.18 outcomes. 11.19 (e) The board must adopt rules requiring successful 11.20 completion of an examination of general pedagogical knowledge 11.21 and examinations of licensure-specific teaching skills. The 11.22 rules shall be effective on the dates determined by the board 11.23 but not later than September 1, 2001. 11.24 (f) The board must adopt rules requiring teacher educators 11.25 to work directly with elementary or secondary school teachers in 11.26 elementary or secondary schools to obtain periodic exposure to 11.27 the elementary or secondary teaching environment. 11.28 (g) The board must grant licenses to interns and to 11.29 candidates for initial licenses. 11.30 (h) The board must design and implement an assessment 11.31 system which requires a candidate for an initial license and 11.32 first continuing license to demonstrate the abilities necessary 11.33 to perform selected, representative teaching tasks at 11.34 appropriate levels. 11.35 (i) The board must receive recommendations from local 11.36 committees as established by the board for the renewal of 12.1 teaching licenses. 12.2 (j) The board must grant life licenses to those who qualify 12.3 according to requirements established by the board, and suspend 12.4 or revoke licenses pursuant to sections 122A.20 and 214.10. The 12.5 board must not establish any expiration date for application for 12.6 life licenses. 12.7 (k) The board must adopt rules that require all licensed 12.8 teachers who are renewing their continuing license to include in 12.9 their renewal requirements further preparation in the areas of 12.10 using positive behavior interventions and in accommodating, 12.11 modifying, and adapting curricula, materials, and strategies to 12.12 appropriately meet the needs of individual students and ensure 12.13 adequate progress toward the state's graduation rule. 12.14 (l) In adopting rules to license public school teachers who 12.15 provide health-related services for disabled children, the board 12.16 shall adopt rules consistent with license or registration 12.17 requirements of the commissioner of health and the 12.18 health-related boards who license personnel who perform similar 12.19 services outside of the school. 12.20 (m) The board must adopt rules that require all licensed 12.21 teachers who are renewing their continuing license to include in 12.22 their renewal requirements further reading preparation, 12.23 consistent with section 122A.06, subdivision 4. The rules do 12.24 not take effect until they are approved by law. 12.25 (n) The board must adopt rules that require all licensed 12.26 teachers who are renewing their continuing license to include in 12.27 their renewal requirements further preparation in understanding 12.28 the key warning signs of early-onset mental illness in children 12.29 and adolescents. 12.30 Sec. 11. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.18, 12.31 subdivision 7a, is amended to read: 12.32 Subd. 7a. [PERMISSION TO SUBSTITUTE TEACH.] (a) The board 12.33 of teaching may allow a person who is enrolled in and making 12.34 satisfactory progress in a board-approved teacher program and 12.35 who has successfully completed student teaching to be employed 12.36 as a short-call substitute teacher. 13.1 (b) The board of teaching may issue a lifetime qualified 13.2 short-call substitute teaching license to a person who: 13.3 (1) was a qualified teacher under section 122A.16 while 13.4 holding a continuing five-year teaching license issued by the 13.5 board, and receives a retirement annuity from the teachers 13.6 retirement association, the Minneapolis teachers retirement fund 13.7 association, the St. Paul teachers retirement fund association, 13.8 or the Duluth teachers retirement fund association; 13.9 (2) holds an out-of-state teaching license and receives a 13.10 retirement annuity as a result of the person's teaching 13.11 experience; or 13.12 (3) held a continuing five-year license issued by the 13.13 board, taught at least three school years in an accredited 13.14 nonpublic school in Minnesota, and receives a retirement annuity 13.15 as a result of the person's teaching experience. 13.16 A person holding a lifetime qualified short-call substitute 13.17 teaching license is not required to complete continuing 13.18 education clock hours. A person holding this license may 13.19 reapply to the board for a continuing five-year license and must 13.20 again complete continuing education clock hours one school year 13.21 after receiving the continuing five-year license. 13.22 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 13.23 2003-2004 school year. 13.24 Sec. 12. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.22, is 13.25 amended to read: 13.26 122A.22 [DISTRICTRECORDINGVERIFICATION OF TEACHER 13.27 LICENSES; DISPLAY.] 13.28 No person shall be accounted a qualified teacher until the 13.29person has filed for record with the district superintendent13.30where the person intends to teach a license, or certified copy13.31of a license, authorizing the person to teach school in the13.32district school system.school district or charter school 13.33 contracting with the person for teaching services verifies 13.34 through the Minnesota education licensing system available on 13.35 the department Web site that person is a qualified teacher, 13.36 consistent with sections 122A.16 and 122A.44, subdivision 1. In 14.1 addition, licensed teachers must prominently display a copy of 14.2 their license or credential in their instructional area or 14.3 office. 14.4 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 14.5 2003-2004 school year and later. 14.6 Sec. 13. [122A.34] [CREDENTIAL FOR EDUCATION 14.7 PARAPROFESSIONALS.] 14.8 Subdivision 1. [RULEMAKING.] The board of teaching must 14.9 adopt rules to implement a statewide credential for education 14.10 paraprofessionals who assist a licensed teacher in providing 14.11 student instruction. 14.12 Subd. 2. [TRAINING POSSIBILITIES.] In adopting rules under 14.13 subdivision 1, the board must consider including provisions that 14.14 provide paraprofessionals with training in students' 14.15 characteristics, supporting the teaching and learning 14.16 environment, academic instructional skills, managing student 14.17 behavior, and ethical practices. 14.18 Subd. 3. [INITIAL TRAINING.] Within the first 60 days of 14.19 supervising or working with students, each paraprofessional will 14.20 receive initial training in emergency procedures, 14.21 confidentiality, vulnerability, reporting obligations, 14.22 discipline policies, roles and responsibilities, and a building 14.23 orientation. 14.24 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 14.25 following final enactment. 14.26 Sec. 14. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.40, 14.27 subdivision 5, is amended to read: 14.28 Subd. 5. [PROBATIONARY PERIOD.] (a) The first three 14.29 consecutive years of a teacher's first teaching experience in 14.30 Minnesota in a single district is deemed to be a probationary 14.31 period of employment, and after completion thereof, the 14.32 probationary period in each district in which the teacher is 14.33 thereafter employed shall be one year. The school board must 14.34 adopt a plan for written evaluation of teachers during the 14.35 probationary period. Evaluation must occur at least three times 14.36 each year for a teacher performing services on 120 or more 15.1 school days, at least two times each year for a teacher 15.2 performing services on 60 to 119 school days, and at least one 15.3 time each year for a teacher performing services on fewer than 15.4 60 school days. The evaluation must be conducted during the 15.5 school year with at least one evaluation completed by March 1 if 15.6 the teacher is performing services in excess of 120 days in that 15.7 school year. Days devoted to parent-teacher conferences, 15.8 teachers' workshops, and other staff development opportunities 15.9 and days on which a teacher is absent from school must not be 15.10 included in determining the number of school days on which a 15.11 teacher performs services. Except as otherwise provided in 15.12 paragraph (b), during the probationary period any annual 15.13 contract with any teacher may or may not be renewed as the 15.14 school board shall see fit. However, failure to provide the 15.15 evaluation required by March 1 under this section will result in 15.16 the automatic extension of that teacher's probationary period 15.17 for one year, unless the school board decides not to renew the 15.18 teacher's contract because of financial limitations of the 15.19 district. An additional failure to provide the March 1 15.20 evaluation results in the automatic renewal of that teacher's 15.21 contract, unless the school board decides not to renew the 15.22 teacher's contract because of financial limitations in the 15.23 district. The board must give any such teacher whose contract 15.24 it declines to renew for the following school year written 15.25 notice to that effect before July 1. If the teacher requests 15.26 reasons for any nonrenewal of a teaching contract, the board 15.27 must give the teacher its reason in writing, including a 15.28 statement that appropriate supervision was furnished describing 15.29 the nature and the extent of such supervision furnished the 15.30 teacher during the employment by the board, within ten days 15.31 after receiving such request. The school board may, after a 15.32 hearing held upon due notice, discharge a teacher during the 15.33 probationary period for cause, effective immediately, under 15.34 section 122A.44. 15.35 (b) A board must discharge a probationary teacher, 15.36 effective immediately, upon receipt of notice under section 16.1 122A.20, subdivision 1, paragraph (b), that the teacher's 16.2 license has been revoked due to a conviction for child abuse or 16.3 sexual abuse. 16.4 Sec. 15. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.46, 16.5 subdivision 9, is amended to read: 16.6 Subd. 9. [BENEFITS.] A teacher on an extended leave of 16.7 absence shall receive all of the health, accident, medical, 16.8 surgical and hospitalization insurance or benefits, for both the 16.9 teacher and the teacher's dependents, for which the teacher 16.10 would otherwise be eligible if not on an extended leave. A 16.11 teacher shall receive the coverage if such coverage is available 16.12 from the school district's insurer, if the teacher requests the 16.13 coverage, and if the teacher either (a) reimburses the district 16.14 for the full amount of the premium necessary to maintain the 16.15 coverage within one monthfollowingpreceding the district's 16.16 payment of the premium, or (b) if the district is wholly or 16.17 partially self-insured, pays the district, according to a 16.18 schedule agreed upon by the teacher and the school board, an 16.19 amount determined by the school board to be the amount that 16.20 would be charged for the coverage chosen by the teacher if the 16.21 school board purchased all health, accident, medical, surgical 16.22 and hospitalization coverage for its teachers from an 16.23 insurer. A school district may enter into an agreement with the 16.24 exclusive bargaining representative of teachers in the district 16.25 where the district agrees to pay all or a portion of the premium 16.26 for such coverage. Any such agreement must include a sunset of 16.27 eligibility to qualify for the payment and must not be a 16.28 continuing part of the collective bargaining agreement. 16.29 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 16.30 following final enactment and applies to agreements in effect or 16.31 entered into after that date. 16.32 Sec. 16. [123B.025] [SCHOOL SPONSORSHIP AND ADVERTISING 16.33 REVENUE.] 16.34 Subdivision 1. [BOARD AUTHORITY; CONTRACTS.] A school 16.35 board may enter into a contract with advertisers, sponsors, or 16.36 others regarding advertising and naming rights to school 17.1 facilities under the general charge of the district. A contract 17.2 authorized under this section must be approved by the school 17.3 board. The powers granted to a school board under this section 17.4 are in addition to any other authority the school district may 17.5 have. 17.6 Subd. 2. [AUTHORIZED AGREEMENTS.] A school district may 17.7 enter into a contract to: 17.8 (1) lease the naming rights for school facilities, 17.9 including school buildings, ice arenas, and stadiums; 17.10 (2) sell advertising on or in the facilities listed in 17.11 clause (1); and 17.12 (3) otherwise enter into an agreement with a sponsoring 17.13 agent. 17.14 Subd. 3. [REVENUE USES.] Revenue generated under this 17.15 section must be used according to a plan specified by the school 17.16 board. 17.17 Sec. 17. [123B.061] [IMPROVING STUDENT ACCESS TO SERVICES 17.18 SUPPORTING ACADEMIC SUCCESS.] 17.19 (a) Districts and the department shall explore 17.20 opportunities for obtaining additional funds to improve 17.21 students' access to needed licensed student support services 17.22 including, but not limited to, medical assistance 17.23 reimbursements, local collaborative time study funds, federal 17.24 funds, public health funds, and specifically designated funds. 17.25 (b) Districts and the department must consider nationally 17.26 recommended licensed staff-to-student ratios when working to 17.27 improve student access to needed student services: 17.28 (1) one licensed school nurse to 750 students; 17.29 (2) one licensed school social worker to 500 students; 17.30 (3) one licensed school psychologist to 1,000 students; 17.31 (4) one licensed school counselor to 250 secondary school 17.32 students and one licensed school counselor to 400 elementary 17.33 school students; and 17.34 (5) one or more school chemical health counselors who may 17.35 be one of the professionals listed in this paragraph if the 17.36 staff-to-student ratios are adjusted. 18.1 School districts shall develop the student services team 18.2 according to the needs as determined by the school board of the 18.3 respective districts. 18.4 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 18.5 following final enactment. 18.6 Sec. 18. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.14, 18.7 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 18.8 Subdivision 1. [OFFICER SELECTION.]Within ten days after18.9the election of the first board in independent districts and18.10annually thereafter on July 1,On the first Monday of January of 18.11 each year, or as soon thereafter as practicable, the board must 18.12 meet and organize by selecting a chair, clerk, and a treasurer, 18.13 who shall hold their offices for one year and until their 18.14 successors are selected and qualify. The persons who perform the 18.15 duties of the clerk and treasurer need not be members of the 18.16 board and the board by resolution may combine the duties of the 18.17 offices of clerk and treasurer in a single person in the office 18.18 of business affairs. They may appoint a superintendent who 18.19 shall be ex officio a member of the board, but not entitled to 18.20 vote therein.In districts in which board members are elected18.21at the general election in November, the annual meeting of the18.22board must be held on the first Monday of January or as soon18.23thereafter as practicable.18.24 Sec. 19. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.90, 18.25 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 18.26 Subd. 2. [STUDENT TRAINING.] (a) Each district must 18.27 provide public school pupils enrolled ingradeskindergarten 18.28 through grade 10 with age-appropriate school bus safety training.18.29The training must be results-oriented and shall consist of both18.30classroom instruction and practical training using a school18.31bus. Upon completing the training, a student shall be able to18.32demonstrate knowledge and understanding, as described in this 18.33 section ofat leastthe followingcompetencies andconcepts: 18.34 (1) transportation by school bus is a privilege and not a 18.35 right; 18.36 (2) district policies for student conduct and school bus 19.1 safety; 19.2 (3) appropriate conduct while on the school bus; 19.3 (4) the danger zones surrounding a school bus; 19.4 (5) procedures for safely boarding and leaving a school 19.5 bus; 19.6 (6) procedures for safe street or road crossing; and 19.7 (7) school bus evacuationand other emergency procedures;19.8and19.9(8) appropriate training on the use of lap belts or lap and19.10shoulder belts, if the district uses buses equipped with lap19.11belts or lap and shoulder belts. 19.12 (b) Each nonpublic school located within the district must 19.13 provide all nonpublic school pupils enrolled ingrades19.14 kindergarten through grade 10 who are transported by school bus 19.15 at public expense and attend school within the district's 19.16 boundaries with training as required in paragraph (a).The19.17school district shall make a bus available for the practical19.18training if the district transports the nonpublic students.19.19Each nonpublic school shall provide the instruction.19.20 (c)AllStudents enrolled ingradeskindergarten through319.21 grade 6 who are transported by school bus and are enrolled 19.22 during the first or second week of school mustdemonstrate19.23achievement ofreceive the school bus safety training 19.24 competencies by the end of the third week of school.All19.25 Students enrolled in grades47 through 10 who are transported 19.26 by school bus and are enrolled during the first or second week 19.27 of school and have not received school bus safety training in 19.28 kindergarten through grade 6 mustdemonstrate achievement19.29ofreceive the competencies by the end of the sixth week of 19.30 school. Students grades 9 and 10 must receive training in the 19.31 laws and proper procedures when operating a motor vehicle in the 19.32 vicinity of a school bus. Students enrolled ingrades19.33 kindergarten through grade 10 who enroll in a school after the 19.34 second week of school and are transported by school bus and have 19.35 not received training in their previous school district shall 19.36 undergo school bus safety trainingand demonstrate achievement20.1of the school bus safety competenciesor receive bus safety 20.2 instructional materials within four weeks of the first day of 20.3 attendance. The school transportation safety director in each 20.4 district must certify to thecommissionersuperintendent of 20.5 schools annually that all students transported by school bus 20.6 within the district havesatisfactorily demonstrated knowledge20.7and understanding ofreceived the school bus safetycompetencies20.8 training according to this sectionor provide an explanation for20.9a student's failure to demonstrate the competencies. The 20.10 principal or other chief administrator of each nonpublic school 20.11 must certify annually to the school transportation safety 20.12 director of the district in which the school is located thatall20.13ofthe school's students transported by school bus at public 20.14 expense have received training according to this section.A20.15district may deny transportation to a student who fails to20.16demonstrate the competencies, unless the student is unable to20.17achieve the competencies due to a disability, or to a student20.18who attends a nonpublic school that fails to provide training as20.19required by this subdivision.20.20 (d) A district and a nonpublic school with students 20.21 transported by school bus at public expensemust, to the extent20.22possible,may provide kindergarten pupils with bus safety 20.23 training before the first day of school. 20.24 (e) A district and a nonpublic school with students 20.25 transported by school bus at public expensemustmay also 20.26 provide student safety education for bicycling and pedestrian 20.27 safety, for students enrolled ingradeskindergarten through 20.28 grade 5. 20.29 (f) A district and a nonpublic school with students 20.30 transported by school bus at public expense must make reasonable 20.31 accommodations for the school bus, bicycle, and pedestrian20.32 safety training of pupils known to speak English as a second 20.33 language and pupils with disabilities. 20.34 (g) The district must provide students enrolled in 20.35 kindergarten through grade 3 school bus safety training twice 20.36 during the school year. 21.1 Sec. 20. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.90, 21.2 subdivision 3, is amended to read: 21.3 Subd. 3. [MODEL TRAINING PROGRAM.] The commissioner shall 21.4 develop a comprehensive model school bus safety training program 21.5 for pupils who ride the bus that includes bus safety curriculum 21.6 for both classroom and practical instruction, methods for21.7assessing attainment of school bus safety competencies,and 21.8 age-appropriate instructional materials.The model training21.9program for students riding buses with lap belts or lap and21.10shoulder belts must include information on the appropriate use21.11of lap belts or lap and shoulder belts. The program must be21.12adaptable for use by students with disabilities.21.13 Sec. 21. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.91, 21.14 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 21.15 Subdivision 1. [COMPREHENSIVE POLICY.](a)Each district 21.16 shalldevelop and implementmaintain a comprehensive, written 21.17 policy governing pupil transportation safety, including 21.18 transportation of nonpublic school students, when applicable. 21.19 The policy, at minimum, must contain: 21.20 (1) provisions for appropriate student bus safety training 21.21 under section 123B.90; 21.22 (2) rules governing student conduct on school buses and in 21.23 school bus loading and unloading areas; 21.24 (3) a statement of parent or guardian responsibilities 21.25 relating to school bus safety; 21.26 (4)provisions for notifying students and parents or21.27guardians of their responsibilities and the rules, including the21.28district's seat belt policy, if applicable;21.29(5)an intradistrict system for reporting school bus 21.30 accidents or misconduct and a system for dealing with local law 21.31 enforcement officials in cases of criminal conduct on a school 21.32 bus; 21.33(6)(5) a discipline policy to address violations of school 21.34 bus safety rules, including procedures for revoking a student's 21.35 bus riding privileges in cases of serious or repeated 21.36 misconduct; 22.1(7)(6) a system for integrating school bus misconduct 22.2 records with other discipline records; 22.3(8) a statement of bus driver duties;22.4(9)(7) where applicable, provisions governing bus monitor 22.5 qualifications, training, and duties; 22.6(10)(8) rules governing the use and maintenance of type 22.7 III vehicles, drivers of type III vehicles, qualifications to 22.8 drive a type III vehicle, qualifications for a type III vehicle, 22.9 and the circumstances under which a student may be transported 22.10 in a type III vehicle; 22.11(11)(9) operating rules and procedures; 22.12(12) provisions for annual bus driver in-service training22.13and evaluation;22.14(13)(10) emergency procedures; 22.15(14)(11) a system for maintaining and inspecting 22.16 equipment; and 22.17(15)(12) any other requirements of the school district, if22.18any, that exceed state law minimum requirements for school bus22.19operations; and22.20(16) requirements for basic first aid training, which must22.21include the Heimlich maneuver and procedures for dealing with22.22obstructed airways, shock, bleeding, and seizures. 22.23(b) Districts are encouraged to use the model policy22.24developed by the Minnesota school boards association, the22.25department of public safety, and the department of children,22.26families, and learning, as well as the current edition of the22.27"National Standards for School Transportation," in developing22.28safety policies. Each district shall review its policy annually22.29to ensure that it conforms to law.22.30 Sec. 22. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.10, 22.31 subdivision 2a, is amended to read: 22.32 Subd. 2a. [CHARTER SCHOOL ADVISORY COUNCIL.] (a) A charter 22.33 school advisory council is established under section 15.059, 22.34 except that the terms of the members shall be three years. The 22.35 members of the council shall be appointed by the commissioner. 22.36 The advisory council is composed of seven members from 23.1 throughout the state who have demonstrated experience with or 23.2 interest in charter schools. The advisory council shall bring 23.3 to the attention of the commissioner any matters related to 23.4 charter schools that the council deems necessary and shall: 23.5 (1) encourage school boards to make full use of charter 23.6 school opportunities; 23.7 (2) encourage the creation of innovative schools; 23.8 (3) provide leadership and support for charter school 23.9 sponsors to increase the innovation in and the effectiveness, 23.10 accountability, and fiscal soundness of charter schools; 23.11 (4) serve an ombudsman function in facilitating the 23.12 operations of new and existing charter schools; 23.13 (5) promote timely financial management training for newly 23.14 elected members of a charter school board of directors and 23.15 ongoing training for other members of a charter school board of 23.16 directors; and 23.17 (6)review charter school applications and recommend23.18approving or disapproving the applications; and23.19(7)facilitate compliance with auditing and other reporting 23.20 requirements. The advisory council shall refer all its 23.21 proposals to the commissioner who shall provide time for reports 23.22 from the council. 23.23 (b) The charter school advisory council under this 23.24 subdivision expires June 30,20032007. 23.25 Sec. 23. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.10, 23.26 subdivision 3, is amended to read: 23.27 Subd. 3. [SPONSOR.] (a) A school board; intermediate 23.28 school district school board; education district organized under 23.29 sections 123A.15 to 123A.19; charitable organization under 23.30 section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 that is a 23.31 member of the Minnesota council of nonprofits or the Minnesota 23.32 council on foundations, registered with the attorney general's 23.33 office, and reports an end-of-year fund balance of at least 23.34 $2,000,000; Minnesota private college that grants two- or 23.35 four-year degrees and is registered with the higher education 23.36 services office under chapter 136A; community college, state 24.1 university, or technical college, governed by the board of 24.2 trustees of the Minnesota state colleges and universities; or 24.3 the University of Minnesota may sponsor one or more charter 24.4 schools. 24.5 (b) A nonprofit corporation subject to chapter 317A, 24.6 described in section 317A.905, and exempt from federal income 24.7 tax under section 501(c)(6) of the Internal Revenue Code of 24.8 1986, may sponsor one or more charter schools if the charter 24.9 school has operated for at least three years under a different 24.10 sponsor and if the nonprofit corporation has existed for at 24.11 least 25 years. 24.12 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 24.13 2003-2004 school year and later. 24.14 Sec. 24. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.10, 24.15 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 24.16 Subd. 4. [FORMATION OF SCHOOL.] (a) A sponsor may 24.17 authorize one or more licensed teachers under section 122A.18, 24.18 subdivision 1, to operate a charter school subject to approval 24.19 by the commissioner. A board must vote on charter school 24.20 application for sponsorship no later than 90 days after 24.21 receiving the application. After 90 days, the applicant may 24.22 apply to the commissioner. If a board elects not to sponsor a 24.23 charter school, the applicant may appeal the board's decision to 24.24 the commissioner. The commissioner may elect to sponsor the 24.25 charter school or assist the applicant in finding an eligible 24.26 sponsor. The school must be organized and operated as a 24.27 cooperative under chapter 308A or nonprofit corporation under 24.28 chapter 317A and the provisions under the applicable chapter 24.29 shall apply to the school except as provided in this section. 24.30 Notwithstanding sections 465.717 and 465.719, a school district 24.31 may create a corporation for the purpose of creating a charter 24.32 school. 24.33 (b) Before the operators may form and operate a school, the 24.34 sponsor must file an affidavit with the commissioner stating its 24.35 intent to authorize a charter school. The affidavit must state 24.36 the terms and conditions under which the sponsor would authorize 25.1 a charter school. The commissioner must approve or disapprove 25.2 the sponsor's proposed authorization within 60 days of receipt 25.3 of the affidavit. Failure to obtain commissioner approval 25.4 precludes a sponsor from authorizing the charter school that was 25.5 the subject of the affidavit. 25.6 (c) The operators authorized to organize and operate a 25.7 school, before entering into a contract or other agreement for 25.8 professional or other services, goods, or facilities, must 25.9 incorporate as a cooperative under chapter 308A or as a 25.10 nonprofit corporation under chapter 317A and must establish a 25.11 board of directors composed of at least five members until a 25.12 timely election for members of the charter school board of 25.13 directors is held according to the school's articles and 25.14 bylaws. A charter school board of directors must be composed of 25.15 at least five members. Any staff members who are employed at 25.16 the school, including teachers providing instruction under a 25.17 contract with a cooperative, and all parents of children 25.18 enrolled in the school may participate in the election for 25.19 members of the school's board of directors. Licensed teachers 25.20 employed at the school, including teachers providing instruction 25.21 under a contract with a cooperative, must be a majority of the 25.22 members of the board of directors before the school completes 25.23 its third year of operation, unless the commissioner waives the 25.24 requirement for a majority of licensed teachers on the board. 25.25 Board of director meetings must comply with chapter 13D. 25.26 (d) The granting or renewal of a charter by a sponsoring 25.27 entity must not be conditioned upon the bargaining unit status 25.28 of the employees of the school. 25.29 (e) A sponsor may authorize the operators of a charter 25.30 school to expand the operation of the charter school to 25.31 additional sites or to add additional grades at the school 25.32 beyond those described in the sponsor's application as approved 25.33 by the commissioner only after submitting a supplemental 25.34 application to the commissioner in a form and manner prescribed 25.35 by the commissioner. The supplemental application must provide 25.36 evidence that: 26.1 (1) the expansion of the charter school is supported by 26.2 need and projected enrollment; 26.3 (2) the charter school is fiscally sound; 26.4 (3) the sponsor supports the expansion; and 26.5 (4) the building of the additional site meets all health 26.6 and safety requirements to be eligible for lease aid. 26.7 (f) The commissioner annually must provide timely financial 26.8 management training to newly elected members of a charter school 26.9 board of directors and ongoing training to other members of a 26.10 charter school board of directors. Training must address ways 26.11 to: 26.12 (1) proactively assess opportunities for a charter school 26.13 to maximize all available revenue sources; 26.14 (2) establish and maintain complete, auditable records for 26.15 the charter school; 26.16 (3) establish proper filing techniques; 26.17 (4) document formal actions of the charter school, 26.18 including meetings of the charter school board of directors; 26.19 (5) properly manage and retain charter school and student 26.20 records; 26.21 (6) comply with state and federal payroll record-keeping 26.22 requirements; and 26.23 (7) address other similar factors that facilitate 26.24 establishing and maintaining complete records on the charter 26.25 school's operations. 26.26 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for fiscal year 26.27 2008 and later. 26.28 Sec. 25. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.10, 26.29 subdivision 20, is amended to read: 26.30 Subd. 20. [LEAVE TO TEACH IN A CHARTER SCHOOL.] If a 26.31 teacher employed by a district makes a written request for an 26.32 extended leave of absence to teach at a charter school, the 26.33 district must grant the leave. The district must grant a leave 26.34for any number ofnot to exceed five yearsrequested by the26.35teacher, and must. Any request to extend the leaveat the26.36teacher's requestshall be granted only at the discretion of the 27.1 school board. The district may require that the request for a 27.2 leave or extension of leave be made up to 90 days before the 27.3 teacher would otherwise have to report for duty. Except as 27.4 otherwise provided in this subdivision and except for section 27.5 122A.46, subdivision 7, the leave is governed by section 27.6 122A.46, including, but not limited to, reinstatement, notice of 27.7 intention to return, seniority, salary, and insurance. 27.8 During a leave, the teacher may continue to aggregate 27.9 benefits and credits in the teachers' retirement association 27.10 account by paying both the employer and employee contributions 27.11 based upon the annual salary of the teacher for the last full 27.12 pay period before the leave began. The retirement association 27.13 may impose reasonable requirements to efficiently administer 27.14 this subdivision. 27.15 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 27.16 following final enactment and applies to approvals of leaves or 27.17 approvals of extensions of leaves made after that date. 27.18 Notwithstanding Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.46, 27.19 subdivision 2, a school district, upon request, must grant a 27.20 one-year extension for the 2003-2004 school year to a teacher on 27.21 a leave of absence to teach at a charter school under this 27.22 subdivision who has been on leave for five or more years as of 27.23 the 2003-2004 school year. 27.24 Sec. 26. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 128C.02, 27.25 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 27.26 Subdivision 1. [DECISIONS, POLICIES, ADVISORY COMMITTEES.] 27.27 The board shall establish and adopt policies, including a policy 27.28 on corporate sponsorships and similar agreements, make decisions 27.29 on behalf of the league, and establish advisory committees 27.30 necessary to carry out board functions. 27.31 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 27.32 following final enactment. 27.33 Sec. 27. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 128C.05, is 27.34 amended by adding a subdivision to read: 27.35 Subd. 1a. [SUPERVISED COMPETITIVE HIGH SCHOOL 27.36 DIVING.] Notwithstanding Minnesota Rules, part 4717.3750, any 28.1 pool built before January 1, 1987, that was used for a high 28.2 school diving program during the 2000-2001 school year may be 28.3 used for supervised competitive high school diving unless a pool 28.4 that meets the requirements of Minnesota Rules, part 4717.3750, 28.5 is located within the school district. A school or district 28.6 using a pool for supervised competitive high school diving that 28.7 does not meet the requirements of the rule must provide 28.8 appropriate notice to parents and participants. 28.9 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 28.10 2003-2004 school year and later. 28.11 Sec. 28. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 169.28, 28.12 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 28.13 Subdivision 1. [STOP REQUIRED.] (a) The driver of any 28.14 motor vehicle carrying passengers for hire, or of any school bus 28.15 whether carrying passengers or not, or of any Head Start bus 28.16 whether carrying passengers or not, or of any vehicle that is 28.17 required to stop at railroad grade crossings under Code of 28.18 Federal Regulations, title 49, section 392.10, before crossing 28.19 at grade any track or tracks of a railroad, shall stop the 28.20 vehicle not less than 15 feet nor more than 50 feet from the 28.21 nearest rail of the railroad and while so stopped shall listen 28.22 and look in both directions along the track for any approaching 28.23 train, and for signals indicating the approach of a train, 28.24 except as hereinafter provided, and shall not proceed until safe 28.25 to do so. The driver must not shift gears while crossing the 28.26 railroad tracks. 28.27 (b) A school bus or Head Start bus shall not be flagged 28.28 across railroad grade crossings except at those railroad grade 28.29 crossings that the local school administrative officer may 28.30 designate. 28.31 (c) A type III school bus, as defined in section 169.01, is 28.32 exempt from the requirement of school buses to stop at railroad 28.33 grade crossings. 28.34 Sec. 29. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 169.4503, 28.35 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 28.36 Subd. 4. [CERTIFICATION.] A body manufacturer, school bus 29.1 dealer, or certified Minnesota Commercial Vehicle Inspector who 29.2 is also an employee of an organization purchasing a school bus 29.3 shallcertifyprovide preliminary certification to the 29.4 department of public safety that the product meets Minnesota 29.5 standards. Final certification will be granted within 30 days 29.6 upon reinspection by the department of public safety. 29.7 Sec. 30. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 169.454, 29.8 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 29.9 Subd. 2. [AGE OF VEHICLE.] Vehiclesten12 years or older 29.10 must not be used as type III vehicles to transport school 29.11 children, except those vehicles that are manufactured to meet 29.12 the structural requirements of federal motor vehicle safety 29.13 standard 222, Code of Federal Regulations, title 49, part 571. 29.14 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 29.15 following final enactment. 29.16 Sec. 31. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 169.454, 29.17 subdivision 6, is amended to read: 29.18 Subd. 6. [IDENTIFICATION.](a)The vehicle must not have 29.19 the words "school bus" in any location on the exterior of the 29.20 vehicle, or in any interior location visible to a motorist. 29.21(b) The vehicle must display to the rear of the vehicle29.22this sign: "VEHICLE STOPS AT RR CROSSINGS."29.23(c) The lettering (except for "AT," which may be one inch29.24smaller) must be a minimum two-inch "Series D" as specified in29.25standard alphabets for highway signs as specified by the Federal29.26Highway Administration. The printing must be in a color giving29.27a marked contrast with that of the part of the vehicle on which29.28it is placed.29.29(d) The sign must have provisions for being covered, or be29.30of a removable or fold-down type.29.31 Sec. 32. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 171.321, 29.32 subdivision 5, is amended to read: 29.33 Subd. 5. [ANNUAL EVALUATION AND LICENSE VERIFICATION.] (a) 29.34A school district's pupil transportation safety director, the29.35chief administrator of a nonpublic school, or a private29.36contractor shall certify annually to the school board or30.1governing board of a nonpublic school that, at minimum, each30.2school bus driver meets the school bus driver training30.3competencies under subdivision 4.A school district, nonpublic 30.4 school, or private contractoralsoshall provide in-service 30.5 training annually to each school bus driver. 30.6 (b) A school district, nonpublic school, or private 30.7 contractor shall annually verify the validity of the driver's 30.8 license of each person who transports students for the district 30.9 with the National Drivers Register or with the department of 30.10 public safety. 30.11 Sec. 33. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 354.094, 30.12 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 30.13 Subdivision 1. [SERVICE CREDIT CONTRIBUTIONS.] Upon 30.14 granting any extended leave of absence under section 122A.46 or 30.15 136F.43, the employing unit granting the leave must certify the 30.16 leave to the association on a form specified by the executive 30.17 director. A member granted an extended leave of absence under 30.18 section 122A.46 or 136F.43 may pay employee contributions and 30.19 receive allowable service credit toward annuities and other 30.20 benefits under this chapter, for each year of the leave, 30.21 provided that the member and the employing board make the 30.22 required employer contribution in any proportion they may agree 30.23 upon, during the period of the leave. The employer may enter 30.24 into an agreement with the exclusive bargaining representative 30.25 of the member under which all or a portion of the employee's 30.26 contribution is paid by the employer. Any such agreement must 30.27 include a sunset of eligibility to qualify for the payment and 30.28 must not be a continuing part of the collective bargaining 30.29 agreement. The leave period must not exceed five years. A 30.30 member may not receive more than five years of allowable service 30.31 credit under this section. The employee and employer 30.32 contributions must be based upon the rates of contribution 30.33 prescribed by section 354.42 for the salary received during the 30.34 year immediately preceding the extended leave. Payments for the 30.35 years for which a member is receiving service credit while on 30.36 extended leave must be made on or before the later of June 30 of 31.1 each fiscal year for which service credit is received or within 31.2 30 days after first notification of the amount due, if requested 31.3 by the member, is given by the association. No payment is 31.4 permitted after the following September 30. Payments received 31.5 after June 30 must include interest at an annual rate of 8.5 31.6 percent from June 30 through the end of the month in which 31.7 payment is received. Notwithstanding the provisions of any 31.8 agreements to the contrary, employee and employer contributions 31.9 may not be made to receive allowable service credit if the 31.10 member does not have full reinstatement rights as provided in 31.11 section 122A.46 or 136F.43, both during and at the end of the 31.12 extended leave. 31.13 Sec. 34. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 574.26, 31.14 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 31.15 Subd. 2. [TERMS.] (a) Except as provided in sections 31.16 574.263 and 574.264 or if the amount of the contract is $75,000 31.17 or less, a contract with a public body for the doing of any 31.18 public work is not valid unless the contractor gives (1) a 31.19 performance bond to the public body with whom the contractor 31.20 entered into the contract, for the use and benefit of the public 31.21 body to complete the contract according to its terms, and 31.22 conditioned on saving the public body harmless from all costs 31.23 and charges that may accrue on account of completing the 31.24 specified work, and (2) a payment bond for the use and benefit 31.25 of all persons furnishing labor and materials engaged under, or 31.26 to perform the contract, conditioned for the payment, as they 31.27 become due, of all just claims for the labor and materials. 31.28 (b) In the case of contracts to create, develop, provide, 31.29 or maintain student information systems, finance systems, Web 31.30 pages, ISP systems, human resources and payroll systems, other 31.31 software, network services, and Internet services, for $25,000 31.32 or more, a contract with a school board is not valid unless (1) 31.33 the contractor demonstrates in its quotation, proposal, or bid 31.34 its financial ability to complete the contract by providing 31.35 financial statements to that effect, and (2) if so required by 31.36 the school board in its specifications or request for proposals, 32.1 the contractor provides a performance bond for the use and 32.2 benefit of the school board to complete the contract according 32.3 to its terms, and conditioned on saving the school board 32.4 harmless from all costs and charges that may accrue on account 32.5 of completing the specified work. Financial statements 32.6 submitted under this paragraph are private data on individuals 32.7 or nonpublic data as defined in section 13.02. 32.8 (c) Reasonableattorneys'attorney fees, costs, and 32.9 disbursements may be awarded in an action to enforce claims 32.10 under the act if the action is successfully maintained or 32.11 successfully appealed. 32.12 Sec. 35. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 611A.78, 32.13 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 32.14 Subdivision 1. [MEMBERSHIP.] A crime victim services 32.15 roundtable is created and shall be convened by the commissioner 32.16 of administration or a designee. The roundtable membership 32.17 shall include representatives from the following: the 32.18 departments of health; human services;children, families, and32.19learning;corrections; and public safety; the supreme court; the 32.20 Minnesota planning agency; the office of the attorney general; 32.21 the office of crime victim ombudsman; the county attorneys 32.22 association; and the office of dispute resolution. The 32.23 roundtable membership shall also include one person representing 32.24 the four councils designated in sections 3.922, 3.9223, 3.9225, 32.25 and 3.9226. 32.26 Sec. 36. [CHARTER SCHOOL ADVISORY BOARD MEMBER TERMS.] 32.27 In order to establish staggered terms for charter school 32.28 advisory board members under Minnesota Statutes, section 32.29 124D.10, subdivision 2a, the commissioner of children, families, 32.30 and learning shall, by lot, determine the length of term for 32.31 each member serving on the board on the effective date of this 32.32 section. One-third of the members shall serve a one-year term, 32.33 one-third shall serve a two-year term, and one-third shall serve 32.34 a three-year term. Thereafter, the term for each member must be 32.35 three years. 32.36 Sec. 37. [PILOT PROJECT TO EVALUATE PARENT INVOLVEMENT 33.1 POLICIES AND STRATEGIES.] 33.2 Subdivision 1. [DISTRICT AND SCHOOL SITE POLICY 33.3 EVALUATION.] A school board may elect to participate in a 33.4 two-year pilot project to evaluate parent involvement policies 33.5 and strategies in the district and in school sites, with the 33.6 goal of improving the academic achievement of all students 33.7 within the district, including at-risk students. Participating 33.8 districts and school sites must establish parent involvement 33.9 review committees consistent with subdivision 2, and may adapt 33.10 the parent involvement policy and process described in United 33.11 States Code, title 20, section 6319, for purposes consistent 33.12 with this project. 33.13 Subd. 2. [PARENT INVOLVEMENT REVIEW COMMITTEES.] A school 33.14 board electing to participate and interested school sites within 33.15 that district must establish a parent involvement review 33.16 committee or expand the purview of an existing committee 33.17 composed of a majority of parents. The committees must evaluate 33.18 the effectiveness of district and school site programs and 33.19 strategies intended to provide all parents with meaningful 33.20 opportunities to participate in the process of educating 33.21 students. The committees, among other things, may evaluate the 33.22 operation of the instruction and curriculum advisory committee 33.23 or building team under Minnesota Statutes, section 120B.11, or 33.24 parent involvement programs developed under Minnesota Statutes, 33.25 section 124D.895. A majority of committee members must be 33.26 parents of students enrolled in the district or school site, if 33.27 applicable. The committee also must include teachers employed 33.28 by the district and who teach at a school site, if applicable. 33.29 A district must assist participating school sites at the request 33.30 of the school site. 33.31 Subd. 3. [NOTICE OF PARTICIPATION; NOTICE TO PARENTS.] (a) 33.32 A school board electing to participate under this section must 33.33 notify the commissioner of children, families, and learning of 33.34 its participation and the participation of interested school 33.35 sites on a form supplied by the commissioner. The commissioner 33.36 may assist participating districts and school sites at the 34.1 request of the district or school site. 34.2 (b) Participating school districts must transmit timely 34.3 effective notice of this project to parent organizations 34.4 throughout the district and to parents of children enrolled in 34.5 district schools. 34.6 Subd. 4. [REPORT.] Participating districts and school 34.7 sites must report the findings of the evaluation and related 34.8 recommendations annually by March 1 to the school board, which 34.9 shall transmit a summary of the findings and recommendations to 34.10 the commissioner. Information the commissioner receives under 34.11 this subdivision may be used to modify guidelines and model 34.12 plans for parent involvement programs under Minnesota Statutes, 34.13 section 124D.895. 34.14 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 34.15 following final enactment and applies to the 2003-2004 and 34.16 2004-2005 school years. 34.17 Sec. 38. [POLICY ON STUDENTS WITH A HISTORY OF VIOLENT 34.18 BEHAVIOR.] 34.19 (a) Representatives of the Minnesota school boards 34.20 association, Education Minnesota, and the information policy 34.21 analysis division in the Minnesota department of administration 34.22 shall develop a model policy by August 1, 2003, on notifying 34.23 classroom teachers and other school district employees having a 34.24 legitimate educational interest when a student with a history of 34.25 violent behavior is placed in the teacher's classroom. The 34.26 model policy at least must: 34.27 (1) define what constitutes a history of violent behavior, 34.28 consistent with Minnesota Statutes, section 121A.45, subdivision 34.29 2, clause (c); 34.30 (2) limit reports on violent behavior to a specified number 34.31 of school years; 34.32 (3) define "legitimate educational interest," consistent 34.33 with Minnesota Statutes, section 121A.64; 34.34 (4) indicate the persons at the school or district level 34.35 who determine which school district employees have a legitimate 34.36 educational interest; and 35.1 (5) require school districts that transfer the student 35.2 records of a student with a history of violent behavior to 35.3 another school district, charter school, or alternative 35.4 education program to include all information about the student's 35.5 history of violent behavior in the student's educational records 35.6 it transmits to the enrolling school district, charter school, 35.7 or alternative education program, consistent with this policy. 35.8 (b) The information policy analysis division in the 35.9 Minnesota department of administration by August 15, 2003, must 35.10 post on its division Web site the model policy developed under 35.11 paragraph (a). 35.12 (c) The task force in paragraph (a) expires on August 1, 35.13 2003. 35.14 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 35.15 following final enactment. 35.16 Sec. 39. [AT-LARGE SCHOOL BOARD MEMBERS; INDEPENDENT 35.17 SCHOOL DISTRICT NO. 709, DULUTH.] 35.18 (a) Notwithstanding Laws 1969, chapter 698, or other law to 35.19 the contrary, the school board for independent school district 35.20 No. 709, Duluth, may by resolution reduce from five to three the 35.21 number of at-large school board members. 35.22 (b) If the school board adopts the resolution under 35.23 paragraph (a), for the November 2003 election and each four 35.24 years thereafter, the three positions of those members elected 35.25 at large whose terms expire on December 31, 2003, shall be 35.26 reduced to one member elected at large. 35.27 (c) Nothing in this section prevents a member of the school 35.28 board on the effective date of this act who is otherwise 35.29 qualified from running for reelection upon the expiration of 35.30 that member's term. 35.31 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 35.32 following final enactment. 35.33 Sec. 40. [REPEALER.] 35.34 (a) Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 124D.93; and 35.35 126C.125, are repealed. 35.36 (b) Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 128C.01, subdivision 36.1 5; 128C.02, subdivision 8; and 128C.13, are repealed. 36.2 (c) Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 123B.90, subdivision 36.3 1; and 169.441, subdivision 4, are repealed. 36.4 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] Paragraph (a) is effective for the 36.5 2003-2004 school year and later. Paragraph (b) is effective the 36.6 day following final enactment. 36.7 ARTICLE 3 36.8 SPECIAL PROGRAMS 36.9 Section 1. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.41, 36.10 subdivision 10, is amended to read: 36.11 Subd. 10. [SUSPENSION.] "Suspension" means an action by 36.12 the school administration, under rules promulgated by the school 36.13 board, prohibiting a pupil from attending school for a period of 36.14 no more than ten school days. If a suspension is longer than 36.15 five days, the suspending administrator must provide the 36.16 superintendent with a reason for the longer suspension. This 36.17 definition does not apply to dismissal from school for one 36.18 school day or less, except as provided in federal law for a 36.19 student with a disability. Each suspension action may include a 36.20 readmission plan. The readmission plan shall include, where 36.21 appropriate, a provision for implementing alternative 36.22 educational services upon readmission and may not be used to 36.23 extend the current suspension. Consistent with section 125A.09, 36.24 subdivision 3, the readmission plan must not obligate a parent 36.25 to provide a sympathomimetic medication for the parent's child 36.26 as a condition of readmission. The school administration may 36.27 not impose consecutive suspensions against the same pupil for 36.28 the same course of conduct, or incident of misconduct, except 36.29 where the pupil will create an immediate and substantial danger 36.30 to self or to surrounding persons or property, or where the 36.31 district is in the process of initiating an expulsion, in which 36.32 case the school administration may extend the suspension to a 36.33 total of 15 days. In the case of a student with a disability, 36.34 the student's individual education plan team must meet 36.35 immediately but not more than ten school days after the date on 36.36 which the decision to remove the student from the student's 37.1 current education placement is made. The individual education 37.2 plan team and other qualified personnel shall at that meeting:37.3 conduct a review of the relationship between the child's 37.4 disability and the behavior subject to disciplinary action;and 37.5 determine the appropriateness of the child's education plan. 37.6 The requirements of the individual education plan team 37.7 meeting apply when: 37.8 (1) the parent requests a meeting; 37.9 (2) the student is removed from the student's current 37.10 placement for five or more consecutive days; or 37.11 (3) the student's total days of removal from the student's 37.12 placement during the school year exceed ten cumulative days in a 37.13 school year. The school administration shall implement 37.14 alternative educational services when the suspension exceeds 37.15 five days. A separate administrative conference is required for 37.16 each period of suspension. 37.17 Sec. 2. [124D.452] [DISTRICT REPORT; CAREER AND TECHNICAL 37.18 EDUCATION.] 37.19 Each district and cooperative center must report data to 37.20 the department of children, families, and learning for all 37.21 career and technical education programs as required by the 37.22 department. 37.23 Sec. 3. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 125A.03, is 37.24 amended to read: 37.25 125A.03 [SPECIAL INSTRUCTION FOR CHILDREN WITH A 37.26 DISABILITY.] 37.27 (a) As defined in paragraph (b), every district must 37.28 provide special instruction and services, either within the 37.29 district or in another district, for all children with a 37.30 disability who are residents of the district and who are 37.31 disabled as set forth in section 125A.02. For purposes of state 37.32 and federal special education laws, the phrase "special 37.33 instruction and services" in the state education code means a 37.34 free and appropriate public education provided to an eligible 37.35 child with disabilities and includes special education and 37.36 related services defined in the Individuals with Disabilities 38.1 Education Act, subpart A, section 300.24. 38.2 (b) Notwithstanding any age limits in laws to the contrary, 38.3 special instruction and services must be provided from birth 38.4 until July 1 after the child with a disability becomes 21 years 38.5 old but shall not extend beyond secondary school or its 38.6 equivalent, except as provided in section 124D.68, subdivision 38.7 2. Local health, education, and social service agencies must 38.8 refer children under age five who are known to need or suspected 38.9 of needing special instruction and services to the school 38.10 district. Districts with less than the minimum number of 38.11 eligible children with a disability as determined by the 38.12 commissioner must cooperate with other districts to maintain a 38.13 full range of programs for education and services for children 38.14 with a disability. This section does not alter the compulsory 38.15 attendance requirements of section 120A.22. 38.16 Sec. 4. [125A.091] [ALTERNATIVE DISPUTE RESOLUTION AND DUE 38.17 PROCESS HEARINGS.] 38.18 Subdivision 1. [DISTRICT OBLIGATION.] A school district 38.19 must use the procedures in federal law and state law and rule to 38.20 reach decisions about the identification, evaluation, 38.21 educational placement, manifestation determination, interim 38.22 alternative educational placement, or the provision of a free 38.23 appropriate public education to a child with a disability. 38.24 Subd. 2. [PRIOR WRITTEN NOTICE.] A parent must receive 38.25 prior written notice a reasonable time before the public agency 38.26 proposes or refuses to initiate or change the identification, 38.27 evaluation, educational placement, or the provision of a free 38.28 appropriate public education to a child with a disability. 38.29 Subd. 3. [CONTENT OF NOTICE.] The notice under subdivision 38.30 2 must: 38.31 (1) describe the action the district proposes or refuses; 38.32 (2) explain why the district proposes or refuses to take 38.33 the action; 38.34 (3) describe any other option the district considered and 38.35 the reason why it rejected the option; 38.36 (4) describe each evaluation procedure, test, record, or 39.1 report the district used as a basis for the proposed or refused 39.2 action; 39.3 (5) describe any other factor affecting the proposal or 39.4 refusal of the district to take the action; 39.5 (6) state that the parent of a child with a disability is 39.6 protected by procedural safeguards and, if this notice is not an 39.7 initial referral for evaluation, how a parent can get a 39.8 description of the procedural safeguards; and 39.9 (7) identify where a parent can get help in understanding 39.10 this law. 39.11 Subd. 4. [UNDERSTANDABLE NOTICE.] (a) The written notice 39.12 under subdivision 2 must be understandable to the general public 39.13 and available in the parent's native language or by another 39.14 communication form, unless it is clearly not feasible to do so. 39.15 (b) If the parent's native language or other communication 39.16 form is not written, the district must take steps to ensure that: 39.17 (1) the notice is translated orally or by other means to 39.18 the parent in the parent's native language or other 39.19 communication form; 39.20 (2) the parent understands the notice; and 39.21 (3) written evidence indicates the requirements in 39.22 subdivision 2 are met. 39.23 Subd. 5. [INITIAL ACTION; PARENT CONSENT.] The district 39.24 must not proceed with the initial evaluation of a child, the 39.25 initial placement of a child in a special education program, or 39.26 the initial provision of special education services for a child 39.27 without the prior written consent of the child's parent. A 39.28 hearing officer, after conducting an impartial due process 39.29 hearing initiated by the district, may override the refusal of a 39.30 parent to consent to an initial evaluation or reevaluation. 39.31 Subd. 6. [DISPUTE RESOLUTION PROCESSES GENERALLY.] Parties 39.32 are encouraged to resolve disputes over the identification, 39.33 evaluation, educational placement, manifestation determination, 39.34 interim alternative educational placement, or the provision of a 39.35 free appropriate public education to a child with a disability 39.36 through conciliation, mediation, facilitated team meetings, or 40.1 other alternative process. All dispute resolution options are 40.2 voluntary on the part of the parent and must not be used to deny 40.3 or delay the right to a due process hearing. All dispute 40.4 resolution processes under this section are provided at no cost 40.5 to the parent. 40.6 Subd. 7. [CONCILIATION CONFERENCE.] A parent must have an 40.7 opportunity to meet with appropriate district staff in at least 40.8 one conciliation conference if the parent objects to any 40.9 proposal of which the parent receives notice under subdivision 2. 40.10 If the parent refuses district efforts to conciliate the 40.11 dispute, the conciliation requirement is satisfied. Following a 40.12 conciliation conference, the district must prepare and provide 40.13 to the parent a conciliation conference memorandum that 40.14 describes the district's final proposed offer of service by the 40.15 district. This memorandum is admissible in evidence in any 40.16 subsequent proceeding. 40.17 Subd. 8. [VOLUNTARY DISPUTE RESOLUTION OPTIONS.] In 40.18 addition to offering at least one conciliation conference, a 40.19 district must inform a parent of other dispute resolution 40.20 processes, including at least mediation and facilitated team 40.21 meetings. The fact that an alternative dispute resolution 40.22 process was used is admissible in evidence at any subsequent 40.23 proceeding. State-provided mediators and team meeting 40.24 facilitators shall not be subpoenaed to testify at a due process 40.25 hearing or civil action under federal special education law, nor 40.26 are any records of mediators or state-provided team meeting 40.27 facilitators accessible to the parties. 40.28 Subd. 9. [MEDIATION.] Mediation is a dispute resolution 40.29 process that involves a neutral party provided by the state to 40.30 assist a parent and a district in resolving disputes over the 40.31 identification, evaluation, educational placement, manifestation 40.32 determination, interim alternative educational placement, or the 40.33 provision of a free appropriate public education to a child with 40.34 a disability. A mediation process is available as an informal 40.35 alternative to a due process hearing, but must not be used to 40.36 deny or postpone the opportunity of a parent or district to 41.1 obtain a due process hearing. Mediation is voluntary for all 41.2 parties. All mediation discussions are confidential and 41.3 inadmissible in evidence in any subsequent proceeding, unless 41.4 the: 41.5 (1) parties expressly agree otherwise; 41.6 (2) evidence is otherwise available; or 41.7 (3) evidence is offered to prove bias or prejudice of a 41.8 witness. 41.9 Subd. 10. [MEDIATED AGREEMENTS.] Mediated agreements are 41.10 not admissible unless the parties agree otherwise or a party to 41.11 the agreement believes the agreement is not being implemented, 41.12 in which case the aggrieved party may enter the agreement into 41.13 evidence at a due process hearing. The parties may request 41.14 another mediation to resolve a dispute over implementing the 41.15 mediated agreement. After a due process hearing is requested, a 41.16 party may request mediation and the commissioner must provide a 41.17 mediator who conducts a mediation session no later than the 41.18 third business day after the mediation request is made to the 41.19 commissioner. 41.20 Subd. 11. [FACILITATED TEAM MEETING.] A facilitated team 41.21 meeting is an IEP, IFSP, or IIIP team meeting led by an 41.22 impartial state-provided facilitator to promote effective 41.23 communication and assist a team in developing an individualized 41.24 education plan. 41.25 Subd. 12. [IMPARTIAL DUE PROCESS HEARING.] (a) A parent or 41.26 a district is entitled to an impartial due process hearing 41.27 conducted by the state when a dispute arises over the 41.28 identification, evaluation, educational placement, manifestation 41.29 determination, interim alternative educational placement, or the 41.30 provision of a free appropriate public education to a child with 41.31 a disability. The hearing must be held in the district 41.32 responsible for ensuring that a free appropriate public 41.33 education is provided according to state and federal law. The 41.34 proceedings must be recorded and preserved, at state expense, 41.35 pending ultimate disposition of the action. 41.36 (b) The due process hearing must be conducted according to 42.1 the rules of the commissioner and federal law. 42.2 Subd. 13. [HEARING OFFICER QUALIFICATIONS.] The 42.3 commissioner must appoint an individual who is qualified under 42.4 this subdivision to serve as a hearing officer. The hearing 42.5 officer must: 42.6 (1) be knowledgeable and impartial; 42.7 (2) have no personal interest in or specific involvement 42.8 with the student who is a party to the hearing; 42.9 (3) not have been employed as an administrator by the 42.10 district that is a party to the hearing; 42.11 (4) not have been involved in selecting the district 42.12 administrator who is a party to the hearing; 42.13 (5) have no personal, economic, or professional interest in 42.14 the outcome of the hearing other than properly administering 42.15 federal and state laws, rules, and policies; 42.16 (6) have no substantial involvement in developing state or 42.17 local policies or procedures challenged in the hearing; 42.18 (7) not be a current employee or board member of a 42.19 Minnesota public school district, education district, 42.20 intermediate unit or regional education agency, or the 42.21 department if the department is the service provider; and 42.22 (8) not be a current employee or board member of a 42.23 disability advocacy organization or group. 42.24 Subd. 14. [REQUEST FOR HEARING.] A request for a due 42.25 process hearing must: 42.26 (1) be in writing; 42.27 (2) describe the nature of the issue about providing 42.28 special education services to the student including facts 42.29 relating to the issue; and 42.30 (3) state, to the extent known, the relief sought. 42.31 Any school district administrator receiving a request for a 42.32 due process hearing must immediately forward the request to the 42.33 commissioner. Within two business days of receiving a request 42.34 for a due process hearing, the commissioner must appoint a 42.35 hearing officer. The commissioner must not deny a request for 42.36 hearing because the request is incomplete. A party may 43.1 disqualify a hearing officer only by affirmatively showing 43.2 prejudice or bias to the commissioner, or to the chief 43.3 administrative law judge if the hearing officer is an 43.4 administrative law judge. If a party affirmatively shows 43.5 prejudice against a hearing officer, the commissioner must 43.6 assign another hearing officer to hear the matter. 43.7 Subd. 15. [PREHEARING CONFERENCE.] A prehearing conference 43.8 must be held within five business days of the date the 43.9 commissioner appoints the hearing officer. The hearing officer 43.10 must initiate the prehearing conference, which may be conducted 43.11 in person, at a location within the district, or by telephone. 43.12 The hearing officer must create a written verbatim record of the 43.13 prehearing conference, which is available to either party upon 43.14 request. At the prehearing conference, the hearing officer must: 43.15 (1) identify the questions that must be answered to resolve 43.16 the dispute and eliminate claims and complaints that are without 43.17 merit; 43.18 (2) set a scheduling order for the hearing and additional 43.19 prehearing activities; 43.20 (3) determine if the hearing can be disposed of without an 43.21 evidentiary hearing and, if so, establish the schedule and 43.22 procedure for doing so; and 43.23 (4) establish the management, control, and location of the 43.24 hearing to ensure its fair, efficient, and effective disposition. 43.25 Subd. 16. [BURDEN OF PROOF.] The burden of proof at a due 43.26 process hearing is on the district to demonstrate, by a 43.27 preponderance of the evidence, that it is complying with the law 43.28 and offered or provided a free appropriate public education to 43.29 the child in the least restrictive environment. If the district 43.30 has not offered or provided a free appropriate public education 43.31 in the least restrictive environment and the parent wants the 43.32 district to pay for a private placement, the burden of proof is 43.33 on the parent to demonstrate, by a preponderance of the 43.34 evidence, that the private placement is appropriate. 43.35 Subd. 17. [ADMISSIBLE EVIDENCE.] The hearing officer may 43.36 admit all evidence that possesses probative value, including 44.1 hearsay, if it is the type of evidence on which reasonable, 44.2 prudent persons are accustomed to rely in conducting their 44.3 serious affairs. The hearing officer must give effect to the 44.4 rules of privilege recognized by law and exclude evidence that 44.5 is incompetent, irrelevant, immaterial, or unduly repetitious. 44.6 Subd. 18. [HEARING OFFICER AUTHORITY.] (a) A hearing 44.7 officer must limit an impartial due process hearing to the time 44.8 sufficient for each party to present its case. 44.9 (b) A hearing officer must establish and maintain control 44.10 and manage the hearing. This authority includes, but is not 44.11 limited to: 44.12 (1) requiring attorneys representing parties at hearing, 44.13 after notice and an opportunity to be heard, to pay court 44.14 reporting and hearing officer costs, or fines payable to the 44.15 state, for failing to: (i) obey scheduling or prehearing 44.16 orders, (ii) appear, (iii) be prepared, or (iv) participate in 44.17 the hearing process in good faith; 44.18 (2) administering oaths and affirmations; 44.19 (3) issuing subpoenas; 44.20 (4) determining the responsible and providing districts and 44.21 joining those districts, if not already notified, in the 44.22 proceedings; 44.23 (5) making decisions involving identification, evaluation, 44.24 educational placement, manifestation determination, interim 44.25 alternative educational placement, or the provision of a free 44.26 appropriate public education to a child with a disability; and 44.27 (6) ordering an independent educational evaluation of a 44.28 child at district expense. 44.29 Subd. 19. [EXPEDITED DUE PROCESS HEARINGS.] A parent has 44.30 the right to an expedited due process hearing when there is a 44.31 dispute over a manifestation determination or a proposed or 44.32 actual placement in an interim alternative educational setting. 44.33 A district has the right to an expedited due process hearing 44.34 when proposing an interim alternative educational setting or 44.35 seeking to maintain placement in an interim alternative 44.36 educational setting. A hearing officer must issue an expedited 45.1 due process hearing decision within ten calendar days of the 45.2 request for a hearing. A hearing officer may extend an 45.3 expedited due process hearing up to five additional calendar 45.4 days. All policies in this section apply to expedited due 45.5 process hearings to the extent they do not conflict with federal 45.6 law. 45.7 Subd. 20. [HEARING OFFICER'S DECISION; TIME PERIOD.] (a) 45.8 The hearing officer must render a decision within 45 calendar 45.9 days of the date on which the commissioner receives the hearing 45.10 request. A hearing officer is encouraged to accelerate the time 45.11 line to 30 days for a child under the age of three whose needs 45.12 change rapidly and who requires quick resolution of a dispute. 45.13 A hearing officer may not extend the time beyond the 45-day 45.14 period unless requested by either party for good cause shown on 45.15 the record. Extensions of time must not exceed a total of 30 45.16 calendar days unless both parties and the hearing officer agree, 45.17 or time is needed to complete an independent educational 45.18 evaluation. Good cause includes, but is not limited to, the 45.19 time required for mediation or other settlement discussions, 45.20 independent educational evaluation, complexity and volume of 45.21 issues, or finding or changing counsel. 45.22 (b) The hearing officer's decision must: 45.23 (1) be in writing; 45.24 (2) state the controlling and material facts upon which the 45.25 decision is made in order to apprise the reader of the basis and 45.26 reason for the decision; and 45.27 (3) be based on local standards, state statute, the rules 45.28 of the commissioner, and federal law. 45.29 Subd. 21. [COMPENSATORY EDUCATIONAL SERVICES.] The hearing 45.30 officer may require the resident or responsible district to 45.31 provide compensatory educational services to the child if the 45.32 hearing officer finds that the district has not offered or made 45.33 available to the child a free appropriate public education in 45.34 the least restrictive environment and the child has suffered a 45.35 loss of educational benefit. Such services take the form of 45.36 direct and indirect special education and related services 46.1 designed to address any loss of educational benefit that may 46.2 have occurred. The hearing officer's finding must be based on a 46.3 present determination of whether the child has suffered a loss 46.4 of educational benefit. 46.5 Subd. 22. [CHILD'S EDUCATIONAL PLACEMENT DURING A DUE 46.6 PROCESS HEARING.] Until a due process hearing under this section 46.7 is completed or the district and the parent agree otherwise, the 46.8 child must remain in the child's current educational placement 46.9 and must not be denied initial admission to school. Until a 46.10 proceeding challenging an interim alternative educational 46.11 placement is completed, the child must remain in the interim 46.12 alternative educational setting until the decision of the 46.13 hearing officer or until the expiration of the 45 days permitted 46.14 for an interim alternative educational setting, whichever occurs 46.15 first, unless the parent and district agree otherwise. 46.16 Subd. 23. [IMPLEMENTATION OF HEARING OFFICER ORDER.] (a) 46.17 That portion of a hearing officer's decision granting relief 46.18 requested by the parent must be implemented upon issuance. 46.19 (b) Except as provided under paragraph (a) or the district 46.20 and parent agree otherwise, following a hearing officer's 46.21 decision granting relief requested by the district, the child 46.22 must remain in the current educational placement until the time 46.23 to request judicial review under subdivision 23 expires or, if 46.24 judicial review is requested, at the time the Minnesota court of 46.25 appeals or the federal district court issues its decision, 46.26 whichever is later. 46.27 Subd. 24. [REVIEW OF HEARING OFFICER DECISIONS.] The 46.28 parent or district may seek review of the hearing officer's 46.29 decision in the Minnesota court of appeals or in the federal 46.30 district court, consistent with federal law. A party must 46.31 appeal to the Minnesota court of appeals within 60 days of 46.32 receiving the hearing officer's decision. 46.33 Subd. 25. [ENFORCEMENT OF ORDERS.] The commissioner must 46.34 monitor final hearing officer decisions and ensure enforcement 46.35 of hearing officer orders. 46.36 Subd. 26. [HEARING OFFICER AND PERSONS CONDUCTING 47.1 ALTERNATIVE DISPUTE RESOLUTION ARE STATE EMPLOYEES.] A hearing 47.2 officer or person conducting alternative dispute resolution 47.3 under this section is an employee of the state under section 47.4 3.732 for purposes of section 3.736 only. 47.5 Subd. 27. [HEARING OFFICER TRAINING.] A hearing officer 47.6 must participate in training and follow procedures established 47.7 by the commissioner. 47.8 Subd. 28. [DISTRICT LIABILITY.] A district is not liable 47.9 for harmless technical violations of this section or rules 47.10 implementing this section if the school district can demonstrate 47.11 on a case-by-case basis that the violations did not harm a 47.12 student's educational progress or a parent's or guardian's right 47.13 to notice, participation, or due process. 47.14 Sec. 5. [DEPARTMENT RESPONSIBILITY.] 47.15 By January 1, 2004, the commissioner must adopt rules that: 47.16 (1) establish criteria for selecting hearing officers, the 47.17 standards of conduct to which a hearing officer must adhere, and 47.18 a process to evaluate the hearing system; 47.19 (2) ensure that appropriately trained and knowledgeable 47.20 persons conduct due process hearings in compliance with federal 47.21 law; and 47.22 (3) create standards for expedited due process hearings 47.23 under federal law. 47.24 By March 1, 2004, the commissioner must develop and make 47.25 available a notice for participants in state-provided dispute 47.26 resolution processes that informs participants of their rights 47.27 concerning dispute resolution. 47.28 Sec. 6. [IMPACT OF WAIVING SPECIFIC SPECIAL EDUCATION 47.29 REQUIREMENTS THAT EXCEED FEDERAL LAW; TWO-YEAR PILOT PROJECT.] 47.30 Subdivision 1. [ESTABLISHMENT; GOAL.] A two-year pilot 47.31 project is established to permit independent school district No. 47.32 535, Rochester, and up to three other geographically diverse 47.33 school districts or cooperative of districts, or both, selected 47.34 by the commissioner of children, families, and learning to 47.35 determine the impact, if any, of waiving specific special 47.36 education requirements listed in subdivision 3 on the quality 48.1 and cost effectiveness of the instructional services and 48.2 educational outcomes provided to eligible students in the 48.3 participating district. 48.4 Subd. 2. [ELIGIBILITY; APPLICATIONS.] The commissioner 48.5 must transmit information about the pilot project and make 48.6 application forms available to interested school districts. 48.7 Applications must be submitted to the commissioner by July 1, 48.8 2003. An applicant must identify the specific special education 48.9 requirements listed in subdivision 3 for which the applicant 48.10 seeks a waiver and indicate how the applicant proposes to modify 48.11 the activities and procedures affected by the waiver. The 48.12 commissioner must approve the applications by August 1, 2003. 48.13 Subd. 3. [WAIVERS.] The following state special education 48.14 requirements are waived for the 2003-2004 and 2004-2005 school 48.15 years for independent school district No. 535, Rochester, and 48.16 the other school districts participating in this pilot project: 48.17 (1) Minnesota Statutes, section 125A.56, governing 48.18 prereferral interventions; 48.19 (2) Minnesota Statutes, section 125A.08, governing 48.20 transitional services; 48.21 (3) Minnesota Statutes, section 125A.22, governing 48.22 community transition interagency committees; and 48.23 (4) Minnesota Statutes, section 125A.023, governing 48.24 coordinated interagency services, but only for eligible children 48.25 with disabilities age six or older. 48.26 Subd. 4. [STUDENTS' RIGHTS.] Eligible students enrolled in 48.27 a district participating in this pilot project remain entitled 48.28 to the procedural protections provided under federal law in any 48.29 matter that affects the students' identification, evaluation, 48.30 and placement or change in placement, or protections provided 48.31 under state law in dismissal proceedings that may result in 48.32 students' suspension, exclusion, or expulsion. Participating 48.33 school districts must ensure the protections of students' civil 48.34 rights, provide equal educational opportunities, and prohibit 48.35 discrimination. Failure to comply with this subdivision will at 48.36 least cause a district to become ineligible to participate in 49.1 the pilot project. 49.2 Subd. 5. [TECHNICAL ASSISTANCE.] The commissioner must 49.3 provide assistance to participating districts, upon request, 49.4 including assistance in developing and implementing a valid and 49.5 uniform procedure under subdivision 6 to evaluate districts' 49.6 experience. 49.7 Subd. 6. [EVALUATION; REPORT.] All participating school 49.8 districts must evaluate the impact, if any, of waiving specific 49.9 special education requirements listed in subdivision 3 on the 49.10 quality and cost effectiveness of the instructional services and 49.11 educational outcomes provided to eligible students in the 49.12 participating district. Districts must focus the evaluation on 49.13 the overall efficacy of modifying the activities and procedures 49.14 affected by the waiver. The evaluation must include a mechanism 49.15 for documenting parents' response to the pilot project. 49.16 Participating districts must submit to the commissioner a 49.17 progress report by September 1, 2004, and a final report by 49.18 November 1, 2005. The commissioner must compile and present the 49.19 results of the reports to the legislature by February 1, 2006, 49.20 and recommend appropriate amendments to the statutory 49.21 requirement listed in subdivision 3. 49.22 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 49.23 following final enactment. 49.24 Sec. 7. [REPEALER.] 49.25 Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 15.014, subdivision 3; 49.26 124D.65, subdivision 4; 125A.09; and 239.004, are repealed. 49.27 ARTICLE 4 49.28 EDUCATION REFORM; FACILITIES AND TECHNOLOGY; FUND TRANSFERS 49.29 Section 1. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 122A.413, is 49.30 amended to read: 49.31 122A.413 [EDUCATIONAL IMPROVEMENT PLAN.] 49.32 Subdivision 1. [QUALIFYING PLAN.] A district may develop 49.33 an educational improvement plan for the purpose of qualifying 49.34 foralternative teacher compensationprincipled pay practices 49.35 aid undersections 122A.414 and 122A.415section 122A.4142. The 49.36 plan must include measures for improving school district, school 50.1 site, teacher, and individual student performance. 50.2 Subd. 2. [PLAN COMPONENTS.] The educational improvement 50.3 plan must be approved by the school board and have at least 50.4 these elements: 50.5 (1) assessment and evaluation tools to measure student 50.6 performance and progress; 50.7 (2) performance goals and benchmarks for improvement; 50.8 (3) measures of student attendance and completion rates; 50.9 (4) a rigorous professional development system, consistent 50.10 with section 122A.60, that is aligned with educational 50.11 improvement, designed to achieve teaching quality improvement, 50.12 and consistent with clearly defined research-based standards; 50.13 (5) measures of student, family, and community involvement 50.14 and satisfaction; 50.15 (6) a data system about students and their academic 50.16 progress that provides parents and the public with 50.17 understandable information;and50.18 (7) a teacher induction and mentoring program for 50.19 probationary teachers that provides continuous learning and 50.20 sustained teacher support. The process for developing the plan50.21must involve district teachers; and 50.22 (8) substantial teacher participation in developing the 50.23 plan, including teachers selected by the exclusive 50.24 representative of the teachers. 50.25 Subd. 3. [SCHOOL SITE ACCOUNTABILITY.] A district that 50.26 develops a plan under subdivisions 1 and 2 must ensure that each 50.27 school site develops a board-approved educational improvement 50.28 plan that is aligned with the district educational improvement 50.29 plan under subdivision 2 and developed with teacher 50.30 participation consistent with subdivision 2, clause (8). While 50.31 a site plan must be consistent with the district educational 50.32 improvement plan, it may establish performance goals and 50.33 benchmarks that meet or exceed those of the district.The50.34process for developing the plan must involve site teachers.50.35 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for fiscal year 50.36 2005 and thereafter. 51.1 Sec. 2. [122A.4142] [PRINCIPLED PAY PRACTICES FOR 51.2 TEACHERS.] 51.3 Subdivision 1. [PRINCIPLED PAY PRACTICES SYSTEM.] A school 51.4 district and the exclusive representative of the teachers may 51.5 adopt, by agreement, principled pay practices under subdivision 51.6 2 to provide incentives to attract and retain high-quality 51.7 teachers, encourage high-quality teachers to accept difficult 51.8 assignments, encourage teachers to improve their knowledge and 51.9 skills, and support teachers' roles in improving students' 51.10 educational achievement. 51.11 Subd. 2. [ELIGIBILITY FOR PRINCIPLED PAY PRACTICES 51.12 AID.] To be eligible for principled pay practices aid, a school 51.13 district must submit to the department: 51.14 (a) A districtwide or site-based educational improvement 51.15 plan as described in section 122A.413. 51.16 (b) An executed collective bargaining agreement that 51.17 contains at least the following elements: 51.18 (1) a description of the conditions or actions necessary 51.19 for career advancement and additional compensation; 51.20 (2) compensation provisions that base at least 60 percent 51.21 of any increase in compensation on performance and not on years 51.22 of service or the attainment of additional education or 51.23 training; 51.24 (3) career advancement options for teachers retaining 51.25 primary roles in student instruction and for other members of 51.26 the bargaining unit; 51.27 (4) incentives for teachers' continuous improvement in 51.28 content knowledge, pedagogy, and use of best practices; 51.29 (5) an objective evaluation program, including classroom or 51.30 performance observation, that is aligned with the district's or 51.31 site's educational improvement plan, and is a component of 51.32 determining performance; 51.33 (6) provisions preventing any teacher's compensation from 51.34 being reduced as a result of implementing principled pay 51.35 practices; 51.36 (7) provisions enabling any teacher in the district if the 52.1 principled pay practices are applied districtwide, or at a site, 52.2 if the practices apply only to a site, to participate in the 52.3 principled pay practices without limitations by quota or other 52.4 restrictions; 52.5 (8) provisions encouraging collaboration among teachers 52.6 rather than competition; and 52.7 (9) provisions for participation by all teachers in a 52.8 district, all teachers at a site, or at least 25 percent of the 52.9 teachers in a district. 52.10 (c) An agreement may contain different compensation 52.11 provisions for separate classifications of employees. 52.12 Subd. 3. [COMMISSIONER APPROVAL.] (a) Before concluding a 52.13 collective bargaining agreement, a district may submit a 52.14 proposed agreement and educational improvement plan for review, 52.15 comment, and preliminary approval by the commissioner. If the 52.16 plan and agreement are executed in the same form as 52.17 preliminarily approved by the commissioner, the plan and 52.18 agreement must be approved without further review. 52.19 (b) The application to the commissioner must contain a 52.20 formally adopted collective bargaining agreement, memorandum of 52.21 understanding, or other binding agreement that implements 52.22 principled pay practices consistent with this section. 52.23 (c) The commissioner's approval must be based on the 52.24 requirements established in subdivision 2. If the commissioner 52.25 does not approve an application, the notice to the school 52.26 district must provide details regarding the commissioner's 52.27 reason for rejecting the application. 52.28 (d) A school district that intends to apply for principled 52.29 pay practices aid for the first time must notify the 52.30 commissioner in writing by November 1 prior to the academic year 52.31 for which they intend to seek aid. The commissioner must 52.32 approve initial applications for school districts qualifying 52.33 under subdivision 4, paragraph (b), clause (1), by January 15 of 52.34 each year. 52.35 Subd. 4. [AID AMOUNT.] (a) A school district that meets 52.36 the conditions of this section, as approved by the commissioner, 53.1 is eligible for principled pay practices aid. 53.2 (b) Principled pay practices aid for a qualifying school 53.3 district, site, or portion of a district or school site is as 53.4 follows: 53.5 (1) for a school district in which the school board and the 53.6 exclusive representative of the teachers agree to place all 53.7 teachers in the district or at the site in the principled pay 53.8 practices system, aid equals $80 times the district's or the 53.9 site's number of pupils enrolled on October 1 of the previous 53.10 fiscal year; or 53.11 (2) for a district in which the school board and the 53.12 exclusive representative of the teachers agree that at least 25 53.13 percent of the district's licensed teachers will be paid under 53.14 the principled pay practices system, aid equals $80 times the 53.15 percentage of participating teachers times the district's number 53.16 of pupils enrolled as of October 1 of the previous fiscal year. 53.17 Subd. 5. [PERCENTAGE OF TEACHERS.] For purposes of 53.18 subdivision 4, the percentage of teachers participating in the 53.19 principled pay practices system equals the ratio of the number 53.20 of licensed teachers who are working at least 60 percent of a 53.21 full-time teacher's hours and agree to participate in the 53.22 principled pay practices system to the total number of licensed 53.23 teachers who are working at least 60 percent of a full-time 53.24 teacher's hours. 53.25 Subd. 6. [AID TIMING.] Districts or sites with approved 53.26 applications must receive principled pay practices aid for each 53.27 school year that the district or site participates in the 53.28 program. 53.29 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for fiscal year 53.30 2005 and thereafter. 53.31 Sec. 3. [122A.4143] [CLOSED CONTRACT.] 53.32 A district and the exclusive representative of the teachers 53.33 may agree jointly to reopen a collective bargaining agreement in 53.34 order to enter into a principled pay practices system consistent 53.35 with section 122A.4142 and an educational improvement plan under 53.36 section 122A.413. 54.1 Sec. 4. [122A.4144] [DISTRICTS RECEIVING ALTERNATIVE 54.2 TEACHER COMPENSATION AID.] 54.3 Districts that qualified for alternative teacher 54.4 compensation aid under section 122A.415 shall be eligible for 54.5 principled pay practices aid provided that they retain the 54.6 system previously approved by the commissioner through June 30, 54.7 2005. These districts must not receive an aid reduction, based 54.8 on the available appropriation, until fiscal year 2006. In 54.9 order to receive aid after June 30, 2005, these districts must 54.10 submit an application to the commissioner under section 54.11 122A.4142. 54.12 Sec. 5. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.57, 54.13 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 54.14 Subd. 2. [CONTENTS OF PROGRAM.] A district must adopt a 54.15 health and safety program. The program must include plans, 54.16 where applicable, for hazardous substance removal, fire and life 54.17 safety code repairs, regulated facility and equipment 54.18 violations, and health, safety, and environmental management, 54.19 including indoor air quality management. 54.20 (a) A hazardous substance plan must contain provisions for 54.21 the removal or encapsulation of asbestos from school buildings 54.22 or property, asbestos-related repairs, cleanup and disposal of 54.23 polychlorinated biphenyls found in school buildings or property, 54.24 and cleanup, removal, disposal, and repairs related to storing 54.25 heating fuel or transportation fuels such as alcohol, gasoline, 54.26 fuel, oil, and special fuel, as defined in section 296A.01. If 54.27 a district has already developed a plan for the removal or 54.28 encapsulation of asbestos as required by the federal Asbestos 54.29 Hazard Emergency Response Act of 1986, the district may use a 54.30 summary of that plan, which includes a description and schedule 54.31 of response actions, for purposes of this section. The plan 54.32 must also contain provisions to make modifications to existing 54.33 facilities and equipment necessary to limit personal exposure to 54.34 hazardous substances, as regulated by the federal Occupational 54.35 Safety and Health Administration under Code of Federal 54.36 Regulations, title 29, part 1910, subpart Z; or is determined by 55.1 the commissioner to present a significant risk to district staff 55.2 or student health and safety as a result of foreseeable use, 55.3 handling, accidental spill, exposure, or contamination. 55.4 (b) A fire and life safety plan must contain a description 55.5 of the current fire and life safety code violations, a plan for 55.6 the removal or repair of the fire and life safety hazard, and a 55.7 description of safety preparation and awareness procedures to be 55.8 followed until the hazard is fully corrected. 55.9 (c) A facilities and equipment violation plan must contain 55.10 provisions to correct health and safety hazards as provided in 55.11 department of labor and industry standards pursuant to section 55.12 182.655. 55.13 (d) A health, safety, and environmental management plan 55.14 must contain a description of training, record keeping, hazard 55.15 assessment, and program management as defined in section 123B.56. 55.16 (e) A plan to test for and mitigate radon produced hazards. 55.17 (f) A plan to monitor and improve indoor air quality. 55.18 (g) A plan to review the department of administration's and 55.19 the department of commerce's B3 project guidelines established 55.20 under Laws 2001, chapter 212, article 1, sections 2 and 3, and, 55.21 when cost-effective, include appropriate modifications as part 55.22 of the project authorized under this section. 55.23 Sec. 6. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.59, 55.24 subdivision 2, is amended to read: 55.25 Subd. 2. [TEN-YEAR PLAN.] (a) A qualifying district must 55.26 have a ten-year facility plan approved by the commissioner that 55.27 includes an inventory of projects and costs that would be 55.28 eligible for: 55.29 (1) health and safety revenue; 55.30 (2) disabled access levy; and 55.31 (3) deferred capital expenditures and maintenance projects 55.32 necessary to prevent further erosion of facilities. 55.33 (b) The school district must: 55.34 (1) annually update the plan; 55.35 (2) biennially submit a facility maintenance plan; and 55.36 (3) indicate whether the district will issue bonds to 56.1 finance the plan or levy for the costs. 56.2 (c) The school district must review the department of 56.3 administration's and the department of commerce's B3 project 56.4 guidelines established under Laws 2001, chapter 212, article 1, 56.5 sections 2 and 3, and, when cost-effective, include appropriate 56.6 modifications as part of the project authorized under this 56.7 section. 56.8 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for revenue for 56.9 fiscal year 2005. 56.10 Sec. 7. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.62, is 56.11 amended to read: 56.12 123B.62 [BONDS FOR CERTAIN CAPITAL FACILITIES.] 56.13 (a) In addition to other bonding authority, with approval 56.14 of the commissioner, a district may issue general obligation 56.15 bonds for certain capital projects under this section. The 56.16 bonds must be used only to make capital improvements including: 56.17 (1) under section 126C.10, subdivision 14, total operating 56.18 capital revenue uses specified in clauses (4), (6), (7), (8), 56.19 (9), and (10); 56.20 (2) the cost of energy modifications, including, when 56.21 cost-effective, compliance with the department of 56.22 administration's and the department of commerce's B3 project 56.23 guidelines established under Laws 2001, chapter 212, article 1, 56.24 sections 2 and 3; 56.25 (3) improving handicap accessibility to school buildings; 56.26 and 56.27 (4) bringing school buildings into compliance with life and 56.28 safety codes and fire codes. 56.29 (b) Before a district issues bonds under this subdivision, 56.30 it must publish notice of the intended projects, the amount of 56.31 the bond issue, and the total amount of district indebtedness. 56.32 (c) A bond issue tentatively authorized by the board under 56.33 this subdivision becomes finally authorized unless a petition 56.34 signed by more than 15 percent of the registered voters of the 56.35 district is filed with the school board within 30 days of the 56.36 board's adoption of a resolution stating the board's intention 57.1 to issue bonds. The percentage is to be determined with 57.2 reference to the number of registered voters in the district on 57.3 the last day before the petition is filed with the board. The 57.4 petition must call for a referendum on the question of whether 57.5 to issue the bonds for the projects under this section. The 57.6 approval of 50 percent plus one of those voting on the question 57.7 is required to pass a referendum authorized by this section. 57.8 (d) The bonds must be paid off within ten years of 57.9 issuance. The bonds must be issued in compliance with chapter 57.10 475, except as otherwise provided in this section. A tax levy 57.11 must be made for the payment of principal and interest on the 57.12 bonds in accordance with section 475.61. The sum of the tax 57.13 levies under this section and section 123B.61 for each year must 57.14 not exceed the limit specified in section 123B.61. The levy for 57.15 each year must be reduced as provided in section 123B.61. A 57.16 district using an excess amount in the debt redemption fund to 57.17 retire the bonds shall report the amount used for this purpose 57.18 to the commissioner by July 15 of the following fiscal year. A 57.19 district having an outstanding capital loan under section 57.20 126C.69 or an outstanding debt service loan under section 57.21 126C.68 must not use an excess amount in the debt redemption 57.22 fund to retire the bonds. 57.23 (e) Notwithstanding paragraph (d), bonds issued by a 57.24 district within the first five years following voter approval of 57.25 a combination according to section 123A.37, subdivision 2, must 57.26 be paid off within 20 years of issuance. All the other 57.27 provisions and limitation of paragraph (d) apply. 57.28 Sec. 8. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.71, 57.29 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 57.30 Subd. 4. [PLAN SUBMITTAL.] For a project for which 57.31 consultation is required under subdivision 1, the commissioner, 57.32 after the consultation required in subdivision 1, may require a 57.33 school district to submit preliminary and final plans for 57.34 approval. The commissioner shall approve or disapprove the 57.35 plans within 90 days after submission. 57.36 Final plans shall meet all applicable state laws, rules, 58.1 and codes concerning public buildings, including sections 16B.59 58.2 to 16B.73, and, when cost-effective, the department of 58.3 administration's and the department of commerce's B3 project 58.4 guidelines established under Laws 2001, chapter 212, article 1, 58.5 sections 2 and 3. 58.6 Sec. 9. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 123B.71, 58.7 subdivision 9, is amended to read: 58.8 Subd. 9. [INFORMATION REQUIRED.] A school board proposing 58.9 to construct a facility described in subdivision 8 shall submit 58.10 to the commissioner a proposal containing information including 58.11 at least the following: 58.12 (1) the geographic area and population to be served, 58.13 preschool through grade 12 student enrollments for the past five 58.14 years, and student enrollment projections for the next five 58.15 years; 58.16 (2) a list of existing facilities by year constructed, 58.17 their uses, and an assessment of the extent to which alternate 58.18 facilities are available within the school district boundaries 58.19 and in adjacent school districts; 58.20 (3) a list of the specific deficiencies of the facility 58.21 that demonstrate the need for a new or renovated facility to be 58.22 provided, and a list of the specific benefits that the new or 58.23 renovated facility will provide to the students, teachers, and 58.24 community users served by the facility; 58.25 (4) the relationship of the project to any priorities 58.26 established by the school district, educational cooperatives 58.27 that provide support services, or other public bodies in the 58.28 service area; 58.29 (5) a specification of how the project will increase 58.30 community use of the facility and whether and how the project 58.31 will increase collaboration with other governmental or nonprofit 58.32 entities; 58.33 (6) a description of the project, including the 58.34 specification of site and outdoor space acreage and square 58.35 footage allocations for classrooms, laboratories, and support 58.36 spaces; estimated expenditures for the major portions of the 59.1 project; and the dates the project will begin and be completed; 59.2 (7) a specification of the source of financing the project; 59.3 the scheduled date for a bond issue or school board action; a 59.4 schedule of payments, including debt service equalization aid; 59.5 and the effect of a bond issue on local property taxes by the 59.6 property class and valuation; 59.7 (8) an analysis of how the proposed new or remodeled 59.8 facility will affect school district operational or 59.9 administrative staffing costs, and how the district's operating 59.10 budget will cover any increased operational or administrative 59.11 staffing costs; 59.12 (9) a description of the consultation with local or state 59.13 road and transportation officials on school site access and 59.14 safety issues, and the ways that the project will address those 59.15 issues; 59.16 (10) a description of how indoor air quality issues have 59.17 been considered and a certification that the architects and 59.18 engineers designing the facility will have professional 59.19 liability insurance; 59.20 (11) as required under section 123B.72, for buildings 59.21 coming into service after July 1, 2002, a certification that the 59.22 plans and designs for the extensively renovated or new 59.23 facility's heating, ventilation, and air conditioning systems 59.24 will meet or exceed code standards; will provide for the 59.25 monitoring of outdoor airflow and total airflow of ventilation 59.26 systems; and will provide an indoor air quality filtration 59.27 system that meets ASHRAE standard 52.1; 59.28 (12) a specification of any desegregation requirements that 59.29 cannot be met by any other reasonable means; and 59.30 (13) a specification, if applicable, of how the facility 59.31 will utilize environmentally sustainable school facility design 59.32 concepts and, when cost-effective, comply with the department of 59.33 administration's and the department of commerce's B3 project 59.34 guidelines established under Laws 2001, chapter 212, article 1, 59.35 sections 2 and 3. 59.36 Sec. 10. [125B.22] [EDUCATION TELECOMMUNICATIONS FUND.] 60.1 Subdivision 1. [FUND ESTABLISHED.] An education 60.2 telecommunications fund is established as an account in the 60.3 state treasury. Earnings, such as interest, dividends, and any 60.4 other earnings arising from fund assets, must be credited to the 60.5 account. 60.6 Subd. 2. [ACCESS FEE.] A surcharge of 25 cents per month 60.7 will be added to end-user bills by communications providers for 60.8 each customer wireline or wireless access line for voice or data 60.9 telecommunications services. 60.10 Fees imposed under this subdivision shall be collected in a 60.11 manner identical to other fees collected under section 403.11, 60.12 subdivision 1. Revenue, including the interest and penalties, 60.13 derived from the fee imposed under this subdivision shall be 60.14 deposited in the education telecommunications fund account. 60.15 Subd. 3. [LEARNING NETWORK.] Commencing in fiscal year 60.16 2004, the account shall fund the kindergarten through grade 12 60.17 schools and public library portions of the learning network of 60.18 Minnesota formerly funded through the department of children, 60.19 families, and learning. Eligible expenditures shall include 60.20 telecommunication access fees, wide-area network maintenance and 60.21 support costs, nonrecurring installation costs, and other costs 60.22 as defined by the Minnesota education telecommunications council. 60.23 Subd. 4. [MINNESOTA EDUCATION TELECOMMUNICATIONS COUNCIL 60.24 (METC).] The Minnesota education telecommunications council 60.25 (METC) has oversight responsibility for the operation of the 60.26 network, and must develop a funding plan consistent with the 60.27 regional distribution method recommended by the 2002 permanent 60.28 funding report. The METC must also establish standards for 60.29 interoperability and minimum bandwidth. 60.30 Subd. 5. [E-RATES.] All kindergarten through grade 12 60.31 schools and public libraries receiving telecommunications funds 60.32 from the state of Minnesota must apply for e-rate discounts 60.33 through the appropriate region or cluster. Regions and clusters 60.34 denied e-rate discounts will be fully funded through the 60.35 education telecommunications fund account. Funds approved 60.36 through the e-rate appeals process are deposited to the account. 61.1 Subd. 6. [FISCAL AGENT.] The department of children, 61.2 families, and learning is the fiscal agent for funding programs 61.3 under this section and is not authorized to, nor responsible 61.4 for, the management or operation of those programs. 61.5 Subd. 7. [ADMINISTRATION.] Not more than $200,000 each 61.6 fiscal year may be expended from the account for paying the 61.7 expenses of the department of children, families, and learning 61.8 in administering this section. 61.9 Subd. 8. [APPROPRIATION.] Money in the account is 61.10 appropriated to the commissioner of children, families, and 61.11 learning for the purposes of this section. Money in the account 61.12 is carried forward. 61.13 Subd. 9. [EXPIRATION.] This section expires June 30, 2009. 61.14 Sec. 11. [APPROPRIATIONS.] 61.15 Subdivision 1. [DEPARTMENT OF CHILDREN, FAMILIES, AND 61.16 LEARNING.] The sums indicated in this section are appropriated 61.17 from the general fund to the department of children, families, 61.18 and learning for the fiscal years designated. 61.19 Subd. 2. [PRINCIPLED PAY PRACTICES AID.] For principled 61.20 pay practices aid under Minnesota Statutes, section 122A.4142: 61.21 $ 3,700,000 ..... 2004 61.22 $42,300,000 ..... 2005 61.23 The 2004 appropriation is for districts receiving 61.24 alternative teacher compensation aid in 2003. 61.25 If the appropriation is insufficient to pay the aid amount 61.26 to all qualifying districts, the commissioner must prorate the 61.27 aid among the districts participating in the principled pay 61.28 practices program. 61.29 The base amount for this program shall be $29,500,000 in 61.30 each fiscal year 2006 and 2007. 61.31 Sec. 12. [REPEALER.] 61.32 Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 122A.414 and 122A.415, 61.33 are repealed. 61.34 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for fiscal year 61.35 2005 and thereafter. 61.36 ARTICLE 5 62.1 FAMILY AND EARLY CHILDHOOD EDUCATION 62.2 Section 1. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 121A.21, is 62.3 amended to read: 62.4 121A.21 [SCHOOL HEALTH SERVICES.] 62.5 (a) Every school board must provide services to promote the 62.6 health of its pupils. 62.7 (b) The board of a district with 1,000 pupils or more in 62.8 average daily membership in early childhood family education, 62.9 preschool handicapped, elementary, and secondary programs must 62.10 comply with the requirements of this paragraph. It may use one 62.11 or a combination of the following methods: 62.12 (1) employ personnel, including at least one full-time 62.13 equivalent licensed school nurseor continue to employ a62.14registered nurse not yet certified as a public health nurse as62.15defined in section 145A.02, subdivision 18, who is enrolled in a62.16program that would lead to certification within four years of62.17August 1, 1988; 62.18 (2) contract with a public or private health organization 62.19 or another public agency for personnel during the regular school 62.20 year, determined appropriate by the board, who are currently 62.21 licensed under chapter 148 and who are certified public health 62.22 nurses; or 62.23 (3) enter into another arrangement approved by the 62.24 commissioner. 62.25 Sec. 2. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.13, 62.26 subdivision 4, is amended to read: 62.27 Subd. 4. [HOME VISITING PROGRAM.](a) The commissionerA 62.28 district that levies for home visiting under section 124D.135, 62.29 subdivision 6, shall use this revenue to include as part of the 62.30 early childhood family education programs a parent education 62.31 componentto prevent child abuse and neglect. This parent62.32education component must include:62.33(1) expanding statewide the home visiting component of the62.34early childhood family education programs;62.35(2) training parent educators, child educators, community62.36outreach workers, and home visitors in the dynamics of child63.1abuse and neglect and positive parenting and discipline63.2practices; and63.3(3) developing and disseminating education and public63.4information materials that promote positive parenting skills and63.5prevent child abuse and neglect.63.6(b) The parent education component must:63.7(1) offer to isolated or at-risk families home visiting63.8parent education services that at least address parenting63.9skills, a child's development and stages of growth,63.10communication skills, managing stress, problem-solving skills,63.11positive child discipline practices, methods of improving63.12parent-child interactions and enhancing self-esteem, using63.13community support services and other resources, and encouraging63.14parents to have fun with and enjoy their children;63.15(2) develop athat is designed to reach isolated or at-risk 63.16 families. 63.17 The home visiting program must: 63.18 (1) use an established risk assessment tool to determine 63.19 the family's level of risk; 63.20(3)(2) establish clear objectives and protocols for home 63.21 visits; 63.22(4) determine the frequency and duration of home visits63.23based on a risk-need assessment of the client, with home visits63.24beginning in the second trimester of pregnancy and continuing,63.25based on client need, until a child is six years old;63.26(5)(3) encourage families to make a transition from home 63.27 visits to site-based parenting programsto build a family63.28support network and reduce the effects of isolation; 63.29(6) develop and distribute education materials on63.30preventing child abuse and neglect that may be used in home63.31visiting programs and parent education classes and distributed63.32to the public;63.33(7) initially provide at least 40 hours of training and63.34thereafter ongoing training for parent educators, child63.35educators, community outreach workers, and home visitors that63.36covers the dynamics of child abuse and neglect, domestic64.1violence and victimization within family systems, signs of abuse64.2or other indications that a child may be at risk of being abused64.3or neglected, what child abuse and neglect are, how to properly64.4report cases of child abuse and neglect, respect for cultural64.5preferences in child rearing, what community resources, social64.6service agencies, and family support activities and programs are64.7available, child development and growth, parenting skills,64.8positive child discipline practices, identifying stress factors64.9and techniques for reducing stress, home visiting techniques,64.10and risk assessment measures;64.11(8)(4) provide program services that are community-based, 64.12 accessible, and culturally relevant; and 64.13(9)(5) foster collaboration among existing agencies and 64.14 community-based organizations that serve young children and 64.15 their families. 64.16(c)Home visitors should reflect the demographic 64.17 composition of the communitythe home visitor is servingto the 64.18 extent possible. 64.19 Sec. 3. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.13, 64.20 subdivision 8, is amended to read: 64.21 Subd. 8. [COORDINATION.] (a) A districtis encouraged to64.22coordinate the program with its special education and vocational64.23education programs and with related services provided by other64.24governmental agencies and nonprofit agenciesmust describe 64.25 strategies to coordinate and maximize public and private 64.26 community resources and reduce duplication of services. 64.27 (b) A district is encouraged to coordinate adult basic 64.28 education programs provided to parents and early childhood 64.29 family education programs provided to children to accomplish the 64.30 goals of section 124D.895. 64.31 Sec. 4. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.15, 64.32 subdivision 7, is amended to read: 64.33 Subd. 7. [ADVISORY COUNCIL.] Each school readiness program 64.34 must have an advisory council composed of members of existing 64.35 early education-related boards, parents of participating 64.36 children, child care providers, culturally specific service 65.1 organizations, local resource and referral agencies, local early 65.2 intervention committees, and representatives of early childhood 65.3 service providers. The council must advise the board in 65.4 creating and administering the program and must monitor the 65.5 progress of the program. The council must ensure that children 65.6 at greatest risk receive appropriate services. If the board is 65.7 unable to appoint to the advisory council members of existing 65.8 early education-related boards, it must appoint parents of 65.9 children enrolled in the program who represent the racial, 65.10 cultural, and economic diversity of the district and 65.11 representatives of early childhood service providers as 65.12 representatives to an existing advisory council. 65.13 Sec. 5. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 124D.16, 65.14 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 65.15 Subdivision 1. [PROGRAM REVIEW AND APPROVAL.] A school 65.16 district shall biennially by May 1 submit to the commissioners 65.17 of children, families, and learning and health the program plan 65.18 required under this subdivision. As determined by the 65.19 commissioners, one-half of the districts shall first submit the 65.20 plan by May 1 of the 2000-2001 school year and one-half of the 65.21 districts shall first submit the plan by May 1 of the 2001-2002 65.22 school year. The program plan must include: 65.23 (1) a description of the services to be provided; 65.24 (2) a plan to ensure children at greatest risk receive 65.25 appropriate services; 65.26 (3) a description ofprocedures and methods to be used65.27 strategies to coordinate and maximize public and private 65.28 community resourcesto maximize use of existing community65.29resources, including school districts, health care facilities, 65.30 government agencies, neighborhood organizations, and other 65.31 resources knowledgeable in early childhood development, to 65.32 coordinate school readiness with existing community-based 65.33 programs and service providers to foster collaboration among 65.34 agencies and other community-based programs that provide 65.35 flexible, family-focused services to families with young 65.36 children, and to facilitate the transition to kindergarten. 66.1 These existing programs and providers include child care 66.2 programs, child care resource and referral programs, early 66.3 childhood family education, Head Start, local interagency early 66.4 intervention committees, special education services, early 66.5 childhood screening, and other education services and programs 66.6 to the extent possible. The district must describe a method to 66.7 share information, responsibility, and accountability among 66.8 service and program providers; 66.9 (4) comments about the district's proposed program by the 66.10 advisory council required by section 124D.15, subdivision 7; and 66.11 (5) agreements with all participating service providers. 66.12 Each commissioner may review and comment on the program, 66.13 and make recommendations to the commissioner of children, 66.14 families, and learning, within3090 days of receiving the plan. 66.15 Sec. 6. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 125A.023, 66.16 subdivision 3, is amended to read: 66.17 Subd. 3. [DEFINITIONS.] For purposes of this section and 66.18 section 125A.027, the following terms have the meanings given 66.19 them: 66.20 (a) "Health plan" means: 66.21 (1) a health plan under section 62Q.01, subdivision 3; 66.22 (2) a county-based purchasing plan under section 256B.692; 66.23 (3) a self-insured health plan established by a local 66.24 government under section 471.617; or 66.25 (4) self-insured health coverage provided by the state to 66.26 its employees or retirees. 66.27 (b) For purposes of this section, "health plan company" 66.28 means an entity that issues a health plan as defined in 66.29 paragraph (a). 66.30 (c) "Individual interagency intervention plan" means a 66.31 standardized written plan describing those programs or services 66.32 and the accompanying funding sources available to eligible 66.33 children with disabilities. 66.34 (d) "Interagency intervention service system" means a 66.35 system that coordinates services and programs required in state 66.36 and federal law to meet the needs of eligible children with 67.1 disabilities ages three to 21, including: 67.2 (1) services provided under the following programs or 67.3 initiatives administered by state or local agencies: 67.4 (i) the maternal and child health program under title V of 67.5 the Social Security Act, United States Code, title 42, sections 67.6 701 to 709; 67.7 (ii) the Individuals with Disabilities Education Act under 67.8 United States Code, title 20, chapter 33, subchapter II, 67.9 sections 1411 to 1420; 67.10 (iii) medical assistance under the Social Security Act, 67.11 United States Code, title 42, chapter 7, subchapter XIX, section 67.12 1396, et seq.; 67.13 (iv) the Developmental Disabilities Assistance and Bill of 67.14 Rights Act, United States Code, title 42, chapter 75, subchapter 67.15 II, sections 6021 to 6030, Part B; 67.16 (v) the Head Start Act, United States Code, title 42, 67.17 chapter 105, subchapter II, sections 9831 to 9852; 67.18 (vi) rehabilitation services provided under chapter 268A; 67.19 (vii) Juvenile Court Act services provided under sections 67.20 260.011 to 260.91; 260B.001 to 260B.446; and 260C.001 to 67.21 260C.451; 67.22 (viii) the children's mental health collaboratives under 67.23 section 245.493; 67.24 (ix) the family service collaboratives under section 67.25 124D.23; 67.26 (x) the family community support plan under section 67.27 245.4881, subdivision 4; 67.28 (xi) the MinnesotaCare program under chapter 256L; 67.29 (xii) the community health services grants under chapter 67.30 145; 67.31 (xiii) the Community Social Services Act funding under the 67.32 Social Security Act, United States Code, title 42, sections 1397 67.33 to 1397f;and67.34 (xiv) the community transition interagency committees under 67.35 section 125A.22; 67.36 (xv) the child care assistance program under chapter 119B; 68.1 and 68.2 (xvi) services offered through the child care resource and 68.3 referral programs under chapter 119B; 68.4 (2) services provided under a health plan in conformity 68.5 with an individual family service plan or an individual 68.6 education plan; and 68.7 (3) additional appropriate services that local agencies and 68.8 counties provide on an individual need basis upon determining 68.9 eligibility and receiving a request from the interagency early 68.10 intervention committee and the child's parent. 68.11 (e) "Children with disabilities" has the meaning given in 68.12 section 125A.02. 68.13 (f) A "standardized written plan" means those individual 68.14 services or programs available through the interagency 68.15 intervention service system to an eligible child other than the 68.16 services or programs described in the child's individual 68.17 education plan or the child's individual family service plan. 68.18 Sec. 7. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 125A.28, is 68.19 amended to read: 68.20 125A.28 [STATE INTERAGENCY COORDINATING COUNCIL.] 68.21 An interagency coordinating council of at least 17, but not 68.22 more than 25 members is established, in compliance with Public 68.23 Law Number 102-119, section 682. The members must be appointed 68.24 by the governor. Council members must elect the council chair. 68.25 The representative of the commissioner may not serve as the 68.26 chair. The council must be composed of at least five parents, 68.27 including persons of color, of children with disabilities under 68.28 age 12, including at least three parents of a child with a 68.29 disability under age seven, five representatives of public or 68.30 private providers of services for children with disabilities 68.31 under age five, including a special education director, county 68.32 social service director, local Head Start director, and a 68.33 community health services or public health nursing 68.34 administrator, one member of the senate, one member of the house 68.35 of representatives, one representative of teacher preparation 68.36 programs in early childhood-special education or other 69.1 preparation programs in early childhood intervention, at least 69.2 one representative of advocacy organizations for children with 69.3 disabilities under age five, one physician who cares for young 69.4 children with special health care needs, one representative each 69.5 from the commissioners of commerce, children, families, and 69.6 learning, health, human services, a representative from the 69.7 state agency responsible for child care, and a representative 69.8 from Indian health services or a tribal council. Section 69.9 15.059, subdivisions 2 to 5, apply to the council. The council 69.10 must meet at least quarterly. 69.11 The council must address methods of implementing the state 69.12 policy of developing and implementing comprehensive, 69.13 coordinated, multidisciplinary interagency programs of early 69.14 intervention services for children with disabilities and their 69.15 families. 69.16 The duties of the council include recommending policies to 69.17 ensure a comprehensive and coordinated system of all state and 69.18 local agency services for children under age five with 69.19 disabilities and their families. The policies must address how 69.20 to incorporate each agency's services into a unified state and 69.21 local system of multidisciplinary assessment practices, 69.22 individual intervention plans, comprehensive systems to find 69.23 children in need of services, methods to improve public 69.24 awareness, and assistance in determining the role of interagency 69.25 early intervention committees. 69.26 By September 1, the council must recommend to the governor 69.27 and the commissioners of children, families, and learning, 69.28 health, human services, commerce, and economic security policies 69.29 for a comprehensive and coordinated system. 69.30 Notwithstanding any other law to the contrary, the state 69.31 interagency coordinating council expires on June 30,20032005. 69.32 Sec. 8. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 125A.30, is 69.33 amended to read: 69.34 125A.30 [INTERAGENCY EARLY INTERVENTION COMMITTEES.] 69.35 (a) A school district, group of districts, or special 69.36 education cooperative, in cooperation with the health and human 70.1 service agencies located in the county or counties in which the 70.2 district or cooperative is located, must establish an 70.3 interagency early intervention committee for children with 70.4 disabilities under age five and their families under this 70.5 section, and for children with disabilities ages three to 22 70.6 consistent with the requirements under sections 125A.023 and 70.7 125A.027. Committees must include representatives of localand70.8regionalhealth, education, and county human service agencies, 70.9 county boards, school boards, early childhood family education 70.10 programs, Head Start, parents of young children with 70.11 disabilities under age 12, child care resource and referral 70.12 agencies, school readiness programs, current service providers, 70.13 and may also include representatives from other private or 70.14 public agencies and school nurses. The committee must elect a 70.15 chair from among its members and must meet at least quarterly. 70.16 (b) The committee must develop and implement interagency 70.17 policies and procedures concerning the following ongoing duties: 70.18 (1) develop public awareness systems designed to inform 70.19 potential recipient families of available programs and services; 70.20 (2) implement interagency child find systems designed to 70.21 actively seek out, identify, and refer infants and young 70.22 children with, or at risk of, disabilities and their families; 70.23 (3) establish and evaluate the identification, referral, 70.24 child and family assessment systems, procedural safeguard 70.25 process, and community learning systems to recommend, where 70.26 necessary, alterations and improvements; 70.27 (4) assure the development of individualized family service 70.28 plans for all eligible infants and toddlers with disabilities 70.29 from birth through age two, and their families, and individual 70.30 education plans and individual service plans when necessary to 70.31 appropriately serve children with disabilities, age three and 70.32 older, and their families and recommend assignment of financial 70.33 responsibilities to the appropriate agencies; 70.34 (5) encourage agencies to develop individual family service 70.35 plans for children with disabilities, age three and older; 70.36 (6) implement a process for assuring that services involve 71.1 cooperating agencies at all steps leading to individualized 71.2 programs; 71.3 (7) facilitate the development of a transitional plan if a 71.4 service provider is not recommended to continue to provide 71.5 services; 71.6 (8) identify the current services and funding being 71.7 provided within the community for children with disabilities 71.8 under age five and their families; 71.9 (9) develop a plan for the allocation and expenditure of 71.10 additional state and federal early intervention funds under 71.11 United States Code, title 20, section 1471 et seq. (Part H, 71.12 Public Law Number 102-119) and United States Code, title 20, 71.13 section 631, et seq. (Chapter I, Public Law Number 89-313); and 71.14 (10) develop a policy that is consistent with section 71.15 13.05, subdivision 9, and federal law to enable a member of an 71.16 interagency early intervention committee to allow another member 71.17 access to data classified as not public. 71.18 (c) The local committee shall also: 71.19 (1) participate in needs assessments and program planning 71.20 activities conducted by local social service, health and 71.21 education agencies for young children with disabilities and 71.22 their families; and 71.23 (2) review and comment on the early intervention section of 71.24 the total special education system for the district, the county 71.25 social service plan, the section or sections of the community 71.26 health services plan that address needs of and service 71.27 activities targeted to children with special health care 71.28 needs, the section on children with special needs in the county 71.29 child care fund plan, sections in Head Start plans on 71.30 coordinated planning and services for children with special 71.31 needs, any relevant portions of early childhood education plans, 71.32 such as early childhood family education or school readiness, or 71.33 other applicable coordinated school and community plans for 71.34 early childhood programs and services, and the section of the 71.35 maternal and child health special project grants that address 71.36 needs of and service activities targeted to children with 72.1 chronic illness and disabilities. 72.2 Sec. 9. [REPEALER.] 72.3 Minnesota Statutes 2002, sections 119A.08; 119A.51; 72.4 125A.47; and 144.401, subdivision 5, are repealed. 72.5 ARTICLE 6 72.6 STATE AGENCIES 72.7 Section 1. [RULES FOR SUPPLEMENTAL SERVICE PROVIDERS.] 72.8 The commissioner of children, families, and learning may 72.9 adopt rules under Minnesota Statutes, section 14.388, 72.10 establishing criteria for identifying, annually reviewing, and 72.11 formally listing eligible supplemental education service 72.12 providers throughout Minnesota, consistent with applicable 72.13 federal requirements and Minnesota's application for 72.14 supplemental education service providers under title 1, part A, 72.15 of the No Child Left Behind Act. 72.16 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 72.17 following final enactment and applies to supplemental education 72.18 service providers delivering supplemental English or math 72.19 services to eligible students in the 2003-2004 school year and 72.20 later. 72.21 ARTICLE 7 72.22 REPEAL OF PROFILE OF LEARNING; STATEWIDE ACCOUNTABILITY 72.23 Section 1. [120B.001] [REPEALING PROFILE OF LEARNING 72.24 STATUTES AND RULES.] 72.25 Notwithstanding sections 120B.02, 120B.30, 120B.31, and 72.26 120B.35, or other law to the contrary, the commissioner of 72.27 children, families, and learning must not implement the profile 72.28 of learning portion of the state's results-oriented graduation 72.29 rule. 72.30 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 72.31 following final enactment and applies to the 2003-2004 school 72.32 year and later. 72.33 Sec. 2. [120B.0012] [STANDARDS AND TIMELINE ESTABLISHED.] 72.34 (a) The commissioner, consistent with the requirements of 72.35 this section and sections 120B.0013 and 120B.0014, must adopt 72.36 statewide rules using the expedited rulemaking process under 73.1 section 14.389 that establish a set of educational standards. 73.2 After the rules authorized under this paragraph are initially 73.3 adopted, the commissioner may not amend or repeal these rules 73.4 nor adopt new rules on the same topic without specific 73.5 legislative authorization. These standards must be implemented 73.6 for all students beginning in the 2003-2004 school year. 73.7 (b) The following learning areas are required for statewide 73.8 accountability: 73.9 (1) read, listen, and view; 73.10 (2) write and speak; 73.11 (3) mathematical concepts and applications; 73.12 (4) scientific concepts and applications; 73.13 (5) social sciences, including history, geography, 73.14 economics, and civics; and 73.15 (6) arts and literature. 73.16 The standards apply to all public school students, except the 73.17 very few students with extreme cognitive or physical impairments 73.18 for whom an individualized education plan team has determined 73.19 that the required standards are inappropriate. An 73.20 individualized education plan team that makes this determination 73.21 must establish alternative standards. 73.22 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 73.23 following final enactment. 73.24 Sec. 3. [120B.0013] [REQUIRED AND OPTIONAL STANDARDS.] 73.25 (a) Minnesota's high educational standards encompass the 73.26 six content areas required for statewide accountability in 73.27 section 120B.0012, paragraph (b). 73.28 (b) For purposes of complying with applicable federal law, 73.29 the commissioner shall establish grade level benchmarks in at 73.30 least the reading, mathematics, and science learning areas. 73.31 (c) A district may adopt state standards or establish its 73.32 own standards in foreign language, career and technical 73.33 education, and physical education. 73.34 (d) The state standards must be supplemented by grade level 73.35 benchmarks, curriculum framework, and test specification 73.36 documents useful to state and local decision makers charged with 74.1 determining appropriate curriculum, staff development 74.2 activities, and assessment programs. 74.3 (e) If a statewide assessment is not provided, a classroom 74.4 assessment determined by the classroom teacher or the local 74.5 school board must be used to assess if a student has met a 74.6 standard. 74.7 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 74.8 following final enactment. 74.9 Sec. 4. [120B.0014] [STATEWIDE AND LOCAL ASSESSMENTS; 74.10 RESULTS.] 74.11 (a) The commissioner must develop assessments for all of 74.12 the required learning areas using state-constructed tests that 74.13 are developed from and aligned with the standards, are designed 74.14 to monitor student growth toward and achievement of those 74.15 standards, consistent with section 120B.35, and satisfy 74.16 applicable federal law. At a minimum, the commissioner must 74.17 require: 74.18 (1) annual reading and mathematics assessments in grades 3 74.19 through 8 and in one high school grade for the 2005-2006 school 74.20 year and later; and 74.21 (2) annual science assessments in one grade in the grades 3 74.22 through 5 span, the grades 6 through 9 span, and the grades 10 74.23 through 12 span for the 2006-2007 school year and later. 74.24 (b) The assessments must: 74.25 (1) provide timely, useful, and understandable information 74.26 for and about the performance of individual students, schools, 74.27 school districts, and the state, consistent with sections 74.28 120B.36 and 120B.364, and expect that educators use the 74.29 information, and other information, to plan instruction for the 74.30 next school year and to develop school improvement plans, 74.31 including plans required under applicable federal law; 74.32 (2) include a growth scale useful under sections 120B.30, 74.33 120B.31, 120B.35, and 120B.36, for analyzing value-added and 74.34 student-level growth over time; 74.35 (3) include state and national percentile ranks in 74.36 information reported to students and parents under section 75.1 120B.364; and 75.2 (4) determine whether students have met the state's basic 75.3 skills requirements in reading and mathematics. 75.4 (c) Consistent with applicable federal law and sections 75.5 120B.30, subdivision 1, paragraph (d), clause (1), and 120B.36, 75.6 subdivision 6, clauses (2) and (3), the commissioner must 75.7 include alternative assessments for the very few students with 75.8 disabilities for whom statewide assessments are inappropriate 75.9 and for students with limited English proficiency. 75.10 (d) Schools, school districts, and charter schools must 75.11 administer statewide assessments under this section that use 75.12 student performance to evaluate student progress in achieving 75.13 high standards in all of the required learning areas as the 75.14 assessments become available. If state assessment is not 75.15 available, schools, school districts, and charter schools are 75.16 responsible for determining if a student has met state 75.17 standards. Schools, school districts, and charter schools may 75.18 base grade promotions and the awarding of high school course 75.19 credits on students' success in achieving high standards. 75.20 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 75.21 following final enactment. 75.22 Sec. 5. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120B.02, is 75.23 amended to read: 75.24 120B.02 [RESULTS-ORIENTED GRADUATION RULE; BASIC SKILLS 75.25 REQUIREMENTS; PROFILE OF LEARNING.] 75.26 (a) The legislature is committed to establishing a 75.27 rigorous, results-oriented graduation rule for Minnesota's 75.28 public school students. To that end, the commissioner shalluse75.29its rulemaking authority under section 127A.05, subdivision 4,75.30toadopt in rule a statewide, results-oriented graduation rule 75.31to be implemented starting with students beginning ninth grade75.32in the 1996-1997 school year. The commissioner shall not 75.33 prescribe in rule or otherwise the delivery system, classroom 75.34 assessments, or form of instruction that school sites must use 75.35 to meet the requirements contained in this rule. For purposes 75.36 of this chapter, a school site is a separate facility, or a 76.1 separate program within a facility that a local school board 76.2 recognizes as a school site for funding purposes. 76.3 (b)To successfully accomplish paragraph (a), the76.4commissioner shall set in rule high academic standards for all76.5students. The standards must contain the foundational skills in76.6the three core curricular areas of reading, writing, and76.7mathematics while meeting requirements for high school76.8graduation. The standards must also provide an opportunity for76.9students to excel by meeting higher academic standards through a76.10profile of learning that uses curricular requirements to allow76.11students to expand their knowledge and skills beyond the76.12foundational skills.All commissioner actions regarding the 76.13 rule must be premised on the following: 76.14 (1) the rule is intended to raise academic expectations for 76.15 students, teachers, and schools; 76.16 (2) any state action regarding the rule must evidence 76.17 consideration of school district autonomy; and 76.18 (3) the department of children, families, and learning, 76.19 with the assistance of school districts, must make available 76.20 information about all state initiatives related to the rule to 76.21 students and parents, teachers, and the general public in a 76.22 timely format that is appropriate, comprehensive, and readily 76.23 understandable. 76.24 (c) For purposes of adopting the rule, the commissioner, in 76.25 consultation with the department, recognized psychometric 76.26 experts in assessment, and other interested and knowledgeable 76.27 educators, using the most current version of professional 76.28 standards for educational testing, shall evaluate the 76.29 alternative approaches to assessment. 76.30 (d) The content of the graduation rule mustdifferentiate76.31betweeninclude minimum competencies reflected in the basic 76.32 requirements assessmentand rigorous profile of learning76.33standards. When fully implemented, the requirements for high 76.34 school graduation in Minnesota must include both basic 76.35 requirements andthe required profile of learning. The profile76.36of learning must measure student performance using77.1performance-based assessments compiled over time that integrate77.2higher academic standards, higher order thinking skills, and77.3application of knowledge from a variety of content areas. The77.4profile of learning shall include a broad range of academic77.5experience and accomplishment necessary to achieve the goal of77.6preparing students to function effectively as purposeful77.7thinkers, effective communicators, self-directed learners,77.8productive group participants, and responsible77.9citizenscoursework requirements that meet state required 77.10 standards established by a local school board. School districts 77.11 shall certify whether students meet state standards using local 77.12 assessments, including student portfolios, if a statewide 77.13 assessment is not available. 77.14 (e)The profile of learning contains the following learning77.15areas:77.16(1) read, listen, and view;77.17(2) write and speak;77.18(3) arts and literature;77.19(4) mathematical concepts and applications;77.20(5) inquiry and research;77.21(6) scientific concepts and applications;77.22(7) social studies;77.23(8) physical education and lifetime fitness;77.24(9) economics and business;77.25(10) world languages; and77.26(11) technical and vocational education.77.27(f)The commissioner shall periodically review and report 77.28 on the assessment processand student achievement with the77.29expectation of raising the standards and expanding high school77.30graduation requirements. 77.31(g) Beginning August 31, 2000, the commissioner must77.32publish, including in electronic format for the Internet, a77.33report, by school site, area learning center, and charter77.34school, of:77.35(1) the required preparatory content standards;77.36(2) the high school content standards required for78.1graduation; and78.2(3) the number of student waivers the district, area78.3learning center, or charter school approves under section78.4120B.031, subdivisions 4, 5, and 6, based on information each78.5district, area learning center, and charter school provides.78.6(h) School districts must integrate required and elective78.7content standards in the scope and sequence of the district78.8curriculum.78.9(i)(f) School districts are not required to adopt specific 78.10 provisions of the Goals 2000 and the federal School-to-Work 78.11 programs. 78.12 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 78.13 following final enactment. 78.14 Sec. 6. Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120B.30, 78.15 subdivision 1, is amended to read: 78.16 Subdivision 1. [STATEWIDE TESTING.] (a) The commissioner, 78.17 with advice from experts with appropriate technical 78.18 qualifications and experience and stakeholders consistent with 78.19 sections 120B.0014 and 120B.36, shall include in the 78.20 comprehensive assessment system, for each grade level to be 78.21 tested,a test, which shall bestate-constructed tests developed 78.22 from and aligned with the state's graduation standards under 78.23 section 120B.0012 and administered annually to all students 78.24 inthe third, fifth, seventh, and eighthgrades 3 through 8 and 78.25 at the high school level. A state-developed test in subjects 78.26 other than writing, developed after the 2002-2003 school year, 78.27 must include both constructed response and multiple choice 78.28 questions for students to show their ability to apply the 78.29 appropriate concepts and knowledge. The commissioner shall 78.30 establish one or more months during which schools shall 78.31 administer the tests to students each school year. Only 78.32 Minnesota basic skills tests in reading, mathematics, and 78.33 writing shall fulfill students' basic skills testing 78.34 requirements for a passing state notation. The passing scores 78.35 of the state tests in reading and mathematics are the equivalent 78.36 of: 79.1 (1) 70 percent correct for students entering grade 9 in 79.2 1996; and 79.3 (2) 75 percent correct for students entering grade 9 in 79.4 1997 and thereafter, as based on the first uniform test 79.5 administration of February 1998. 79.6 (b) The third, fifth, and sevenththrough eighth grade and 79.7 high school level test results shall be available to districts 79.8 for diagnostic purposes affecting student learning and district 79.9 instruction and curriculum, and for establishing educational 79.10 accountability. The score of statewide tests taken in grades 9 79.11 through 12 must be recorded on the student's transcript. The 79.12 commissioner must disseminate to the public thethird, fifth,79.13and seventh gradetest results upon receiving those results. 79.14 (c)In addition, at the high school level, districts shall79.15assess student performance in all required learning areas and79.16selected required standards within each area of the profile of79.17learning. The testing instruments,State tests must be 79.18 constructed and aligned with the state standards. The testing 79.19 process, and the order of administration shall be determined by 79.20 the commissioner. The statewide results shall be aggregated at 79.21 the site and district level, consistent with section 120B.0014. 79.22 (d)The commissioner shall report school site and school79.23district student academic achievement levels of the current and79.24two immediately preceding school years. The report shall79.25include students' unweighted mean test scores in each tested79.26subject, the unweighted mean test scores of only those students79.27enrolled in the school by October 1 of the current school year,79.28and the unweighted test scores of all students except those79.29students receiving limited English proficiency instruction. The79.30report also shall record separately, in proximity to the79.31reported performance levels, the percentage of students of each79.32gender and the percentages of students who are eligible to79.33receive a free or reduced price school meal, demonstrate limited79.34English proficiency, are identified as migrant students, are a79.35member of a major ethnic or racial population, or are eligible79.36to receive special education services.80.1(e)In addition to the testing and reporting requirements 80.2 underparagraphs (a), (b), (c), and (d)sections 120B.36 and 80.3 120B.364, the commissioner shall include the following 80.4 components in the statewide public reporting system: 80.5 (1) uniform statewide testing of allthird, fifth, seventh,80.6eighth, and post-eighth gradestudents in grades 3 through 8 and 80.7 at the high school level that provides exemptions, only with 80.8 parent or guardian approval, for those very few students for 80.9 whom the student's individual education plan team under sections 80.10 125A.05 and 125A.06, determines that the student is incapable of 80.11 taking a statewide test, or for a limited English proficiency 80.12 student under section 124D.59, subdivision 2, if the student has 80.13 been in the United States for fewer than12 months and for whom80.14special language barriers exist, such as the student's native80.15language does not have a written form or the district does not80.16have access to appropriate interpreter services for the80.17student's native languagethree years; 80.18 (2) educational indicators that can be aggregated and 80.19 compared across school districts and across time on a statewide 80.20 basis, including average daily attendance, high school 80.21 graduation rates, and high school drop-out rates by age and 80.22 grade level; 80.23 (3) students' scores on the American College Test; and 80.24 (4) state results from participation in the National 80.25 Assessment of Educational Progress so that the state can 80.26 benchmark its performance against the nation and other states, 80.27 and, where possible, against other countries, and contribute to 80.28 the national effort to monitor achievement. 80.29(f)(e) Districts must report exemptions under paragraph 80.30(e)(d), clause (1), to the commissioner consistent with a 80.31 format provided by the commissioner. 80.32 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 80.33 following final enactment and applies to the 2005-2006 school 80.34 year and later. 80.35 Sec. 7. [120B.36] [SCHOOL ACCOUNTABILITY.] 80.36 Subdivision 1. [SCHOOL PERFORMANCE MEASURES.] (a) The 81.1 commissioner, consistent with the requirements under this 81.2 section and sections 120B.361, 120B.362, 120B.363, and 120B.364, 81.3 must adopt statewide rules under chapter 14 that establish 81.4 school and district accountability measures. The commissioner 81.5 must make available for public review a statement of the need 81.6 for and reasonableness of each rule consistent with section 81.7 14.131. After the rules authorized under this paragraph are 81.8 initially adopted, the commissioner may not amend or repeal 81.9 these rules nor adopt new rules on the same topic without 81.10 specific legislative authorization. 81.11 (b) The commissioner must use at least the following seven 81.12 indicators to measure schools' performance: 81.13 (1) statewide assessment scores in mathematics, reading, 81.14 and science; 81.15 (2) student attendance rates; 81.16 (3) high school student graduation rates; 81.17 (4) the English proficiency of limited English proficiency 81.18 students; 81.19 (5) an index of attainment for special education students 81.20 taking an alternative assessment; 81.21 (6) teacher quality indicators; and 81.22 (7) school safety measures. 81.23 (c) The commissioner must use the indicators under 81.24 paragraph (b), and the definition of adequate yearly progress 81.25 under section 120B.35, and this section to designate public 81.26 schools as "superior," "excellent," "meets expectations," "under 81.27 review," or "low-performing" under section 120B.361. Only those 81.28 schools that satisfy the definition of adequate yearly progress 81.29 can be designated as "superior," "excellent," or "meets 81.30 expectations." 81.31 Subd. 2. [LOW-PERFORMING SCHOOLS AND DISTRICTS.] (a) 81.32 Schools and districts that fail to demonstrate adequate yearly 81.33 progress for two consecutive school years are designated as 81.34 "low-performing" schools or districts. Schools and districts 81.35 fail to make adequate yearly progress for two consecutive school 81.36 years if: 82.1 (1) the school or district as a whole fails to make 82.2 adequate yearly progress for two consecutive school years; or 82.3 (2) an identified student subgroup within the school or 82.4 district fails to make adequate yearly progress for two 82.5 consecutive school years, where subgroups are defined by limited 82.6 English proficiency status, special education status, ethnicity, 82.7 and eligibility for free or reduced price lunch. 82.8 (b) A school or district designated as low-performing must 82.9 meet its adequate yearly progress target for two consecutive 82.10 school years before the designation is removed. A school or 82.11 district that meets its adequate yearly progress target for one 82.12 year after its designation as low-performing remains subject to 82.13 the sanctions then in effect but receives no added sanctions. 82.14 Subd. 3. [STUDENT PARTICIPATION REQUIREMENTS.] Schools 82.15 with 40 or more students must satisfy the participation 82.16 requirement under this subdivision to demonstrate adequate 82.17 yearly progress. A school must administer statewide assessments 82.18 in mathematics, reading, and science to at least 95 percent of 82.19 its students enrolled on the day of testing. Schools must count 82.20 as absent from testing those students who: 82.21 (1) are absent and do not make up the test; or 82.22 (2) withdraw from testing at the request of the student's 82.23 parent or guardian. 82.24 A student who is absent from the testing and the test 82.25 makeup and has a verifiable medical excuse for the testing and 82.26 test makeup is not counted as an absent student. 82.27 Subd. 4. [ADEQUATE YEARLY PROGRESS COMPONENTS FOR 82.28 ELEMENTARY AND INTERMEDIATE SCHOOLS.] (a) Elementary and 82.29 intermediate schools with 20 or more students enrolled for at 82.30 least one month during the school year must use attendance rates 82.31 to demonstrate adequate yearly progress. Elementary and 82.32 intermediate schools with 20 or more students tested must use 82.33 statewide assessment scores in mathematics, reading, and science 82.34 to demonstrate adequate yearly progress. 82.35 (b) To demonstrate adequate yearly progress using 82.36 attendance rates, an elementary and intermediate school must: 83.1 (1) have a 95 percent average daily attendance rate for the 83.2 previous school year; or 83.3 (2) using the 2002-2003 school year as its base year, 83.4 demonstrate an annual increase in the average daily attendance 83.5 rate so that, if the improvement continues at the same rate, the 83.6 school has a 95 percent average daily attendance rate by the 83.7 2013-2014 school year. 83.8 (c) To demonstrate adequate yearly progress using students' 83.9 statewide assessment scores in mathematics, reading, and 83.10 science, an elementary and intermediate school must meet the 83.11 annual measurable objective for the school and for every 83.12 identified student subgroup of 20 or more tested students within 83.13 the school, based upon the school's proficiency index calculated 83.14 under subdivision 7. 83.15 (d) The commissioner must: 83.16 (1) set schools' measurable objective consistent with 83.17 applicable federal law; 83.18 (2) incorporate federal "safe harbor" provisions in all 83.19 adequate yearly progress determinations that are based upon 83.20 students' statewide achievement test scores; and 83.21 (3) apply confidence intervals to prevent erroneous 83.22 "low-performing" designations that are due to a small student 83.23 population within a school or within an identified student 83.24 subgroup. 83.25 Subd. 5. [ADEQUATE YEARLY PROGRESS COMPONENTS FOR HIGH 83.26 SCHOOLS.] (a) High schools with 20 or more students terminating 83.27 their education by graduating during the current school year or 83.28 dropping out during the previous four school years under 83.29 paragraph (b) must use graduation rates to demonstrate adequate 83.30 yearly progress. High schools with 20 or more students tested 83.31 must use statewide assessment scores in mathematics, reading, 83.32 and science to demonstrate adequate yearly progress. 83.33 (b) To demonstrate adequate yearly progress using 83.34 graduation rates, a high school must: 83.35 (1) have an 80 percent graduation rate for the previous 83.36 school year; or 84.1 (2) using the 2002-2003 school year as its base year, 84.2 demonstrate an annual increase in the graduation rate so that, 84.3 if improvement continues at the same rate, the school has an 80 84.4 percent graduation rate by the 2013-2014 school year. 84.5 A school's graduation rate is based on the number of students 84.6 terminating their education by graduating or dropping out during 84.7 the four-year period over which the graduation rate is computed 84.8 using the quasi-cohort method of the National Center on 84.9 Education Statistics. 84.10 (c) To demonstrate adequate yearly progress using students' 84.11 statewide reading and mathematics assessment scores, a high 84.12 school must meet the annual measurable objective for the school 84.13 and for every identified student subgroup of 20 or more tested 84.14 students within the school based upon the school's proficiency 84.15 index calculated under subdivision 7. 84.16 (d) The commissioner must: 84.17 (1) set schools' measurable objective consistent with 84.18 applicable federal law; 84.19 (2) incorporate federal "safe harbor" provisions in all 84.20 adequate yearly progress determinations that are based upon 84.21 students' statewide assessment scores in mathematics and 84.22 reading; and 84.23 (3) apply confidence intervals to prevent erroneous 84.24 "low-performing" designations that are due to a small student 84.25 population within a school or within an identified student 84.26 subgroup. 84.27 Subd. 6. [PERFORMANCES THAT DETERMINE ADEQUATE YEARLY 84.28 PROGRESS.] For purposes of the proficiency index of a school or 84.29 district, adequate yearly progress is determined based on the 84.30 performances of: 84.31 (1) those students enrolled in the school or district for 84.32 at least one school year, including those students with 84.33 disabilities taking a standard or accommodated form of the 84.34 statewide assessment, and limited English proficiency students 84.35 taking a standard or accommodated form of the statewide 84.36 assessment; 85.1 (2) the very few students under sections 120B.0012, 85.2 paragraph (b), and 120B.30, subdivision 1, paragraph (e), clause 85.3 (1), who take an alternative assessment are included in the 85.4 accountability system using a separate special education 85.5 attainment index; and 85.6 (3) those students under section 120B.30, subdivision 1, 85.7 paragraph (d), clause (1), who take the Minnesota test of 85.8 emerging academic English are included in the accountability 85.9 system using a separate limited English proficiency attainment 85.10 index. 85.11 Subd. 7. [PROFICIENCY INDEX CALCULATION.] The proficiency 85.12 index of a school or district equals: 85.13 (1) 100 times the number of students scoring at or above 85.14 level IIb; plus 85.15 (2) 50 times the number of students scoring in level IIa; 85.16 divided by 85.17 (3) the total number of students tested. 85.18 Consistent with applicable federal law, the proficiency 85.19 index reaches 100 only if all students in the school or district 85.20 score at or above level IIb by the 2013-2014 school year. 85.21 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 85.22 following final enactment and applies to the 2005-2006 school 85.23 year and later. 85.24 Sec. 8. [120B.361] [SCHOOL AND DISTRICT DESIGNATIONS.] 85.25 Subdivision 1. [UNDER REVIEW; LOW-PERFORMING.] A school or 85.26 district that fails to meet its adequate yearly progress targets 85.27 for one school year is designated "under review." A school or 85.28 district that fails to meet its adequate yearly progress targets 85.29 for two consecutive school years is designated "low-performing." 85.30 Subd. 2. [MEETS EXPECTATIONS.] A school or district is 85.31 designated as "meets expectations" if it: 85.32 (1) does not qualify for a "superior" or "excellent" 85.33 designation; 85.34 (2) met its adequate yearly progress targets for each of 85.35 the last two school years; or 85.36 (3) met its adequate yearly progress targets one school 86.1 year after being designated "under review." 86.2 Subd. 3. [EXCELLENT DESIGNATION.] (a) A school or district 86.3 is designated "excellent" if it meets its adequate yearly 86.4 progress target for two consecutive school years and satisfies 86.5 the criteria described in paragraphs (b) to (f). 86.6 (b) All students enrolled at least one school year taking 86.7 the regular or an accommodated form of statewide assessments: 86.8 (1) received average reading and mathematics scores above 86.9 1500; 86.10 (2) showed a mean score improvement rate in reading and 86.11 mathematics that brings students' scores to 1500 within five 86.12 school years; or 86.13 (3) showed average reading and mathematics scores exceeding 86.14 the estimated state average for schools with similar student 86.15 populations based on the combined percent of tested students who 86.16 are either eligible for a free or reduced price lunch, have an 86.17 individualized education plan, or have limited English 86.18 proficiency. 86.19 After two years of statewide annual testing in grades 3 86.20 through 8, elementary schools must be designated "excellent" 86.21 based on value-added, grade-to-grade gains in student 86.22 achievement, consistent with section 120B.35, and not based on 86.23 comparisons of schools with similar student populations under 86.24 clause (3). 86.25 (c) The school has at least a 95 percent average daily 86.26 attendance rate or improved its average daily attendance rate in 86.27 each of the last two consecutive school years so that, if 86.28 improvement continues at the same rate, it has a 95 percent 86.29 average daily attendance rate within five school years. 86.30 (d) A high school has at least a 90 percent graduation rate 86.31 or improved its graduation rate in each of the last two 86.32 consecutive school years so that, if improvement continues at 86.33 the same rate, it has a 90 percent graduation rate within five 86.34 school years. 86.35 (e) All teachers teaching English, mathematics, science, 86.36 social sciences, arts and literature, and foreign languages must 87.1 satisfy the definition of qualified teacher under section 87.2 122A.16. 87.3 (f) The school is a safe and drug-free school and not 87.4 designated a persistently dangerous school under section 87.5 120B.362. 87.6 (g) An excellent school or district deserves public 87.7 recognition and onetime financial awards that allow the school 87.8 or district to improve facilities and increase capacity to serve 87.9 students through intradistrict transfers or open enrollment 87.10 under section 124D.03. 87.11 Subd. 4. [SUPERIOR DESIGNATION.] (a) A school or district 87.12 is designated "superior" if it meets all the qualifications for 87.13 an "excellent" designation under subdivision 3 and evidences 87.14 best practices in curriculum, instruction, assessment, 87.15 professional development, parent and community involvement, 87.16 leadership, governance, and use of resources that are useful to 87.17 other schools or districts seeking to improve performance. 87.18 Evidence of a superior school or district may include the number 87.19 of students residing either outside the school attendance area 87.20 or the school district who seek to enroll in the school or 87.21 district. 87.22 (b) A superior school or district deserves public 87.23 recognition and onetime financial awards that allow the school 87.24 or district to improve facilities and increase capacity to serve 87.25 students through intradistrict transfers or open enrollment 87.26 under section 124D.03. 87.27 Subd. 5. [APPEALS.] A school or district may appeal in 87.28 writing a designation under this section to the accountability 87.29 advisory council under section 120B.365 within 30 days of 87.30 receiving the designation. The accountability advisory council 87.31 must advise the commissioner regarding the appeal. The 87.32 commissioner's decision to uphold or deny an appeal is final. 87.33 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 87.34 following final enactment and applies to the 2005-2006 school 87.35 year and later. 87.36 Sec. 9. [120B.362] [PERSISTENTLY DANGEROUS SCHOOLS.] 88.1 Subdivision 1. [DEFINITION.] A public school is a 88.2 persistently dangerous school if, during two of the three 88.3 previous school years: 88.4 (1) a student attending the school was disciplined under 88.5 section 121A.44 for bringing to school a firearm as defined in 88.6 United States Code, title 18, section 921; and 88.7 (2) the number of students disciplined under the Pupil Fair 88.8 Dismissal Act, sections 121A.40 to 121A.56, for offenses 88.9 committed on school grounds under subdivision 2 exceeds the 88.10 number of total annual incidents under subdivision 3. 88.11 Subd. 2. [DANGEROUS OFFENSES.] Offenses that must be 88.12 counted for purposes of defining a persistently dangerous school 88.13 include: 88.14 (1) possessing a dangerous weapon as defined in United 88.15 States Code, title 18, section 930, paragraph (g)(2); 88.16 (2) possessing or using a controlled substance under 88.17 section 152.01, subdivisions 4 and 9, and consistent with 88.18 applicable federal law; 88.19 (3) selling or soliciting the sale of a controlled 88.20 substance under section 152.01, subdivisions 4 and 9, and 88.21 consistent with applicable federal law; and 88.22 (4) committing third degree assault under section 609.223, 88.23 subdivision 1, or criminal sexual conduct under sections 609.342 88.24 to 609.3452. 88.25 Subd. 3. [TOTAL ANNUAL INCIDENTS.] A designation as a 88.26 persistently dangerous school requires that the total annual 88.27 number of offenses listed under subdivision 2 exceeds three 88.28 incidents in a school with fewer than 300 enrolled students or 88.29 one incident for every 100 students or fraction of 100 students 88.30 in a school with 300 or more enrolled students. 88.31 Subd. 4. [DANGEROUS INCIDENT.] (a) The commissioner must 88.32 review by January of each year the data from the three previous 88.33 school years that are included in the dangerous weapons reports 88.34 under section 121A.06. The commissioner must: 88.35 (1) base the initial "persistently dangerous school" 88.36 designations on these data; 89.1 (2) use the October 1 child count under section 120A.24 to 89.2 establish student enrollment levels; and 89.3 (3) provide preliminary notice of a "persistently dangerous 89.4 school" designation to schools and districts in February of each 89.5 year. 89.6 (b) A district may appeal a "persistently dangerous school" 89.7 designation under subdivision 5. If the commissioner upholds 89.8 the appeal, the commissioner must notify the affected school and 89.9 district by June 1 that the "persistently dangerous school" 89.10 designation does not apply. If the commissioner denies the 89.11 appeal, the commissioner must notify the affected school and 89.12 district by June that the "persistently dangerous school" 89.13 designation applies. 89.14 Subd. 5. [APPEAL OF DESIGNATION.] A school district may 89.15 submit to the accountability advisory council under section 89.16 120B.365 a written appeal of a persistently dangerous school 89.17 designation within 30 days of receiving the designation. The 89.18 appeal must show that the conditions under subdivisions 1 and 2 89.19 did not exist in two of the three previous school years. The 89.20 accountability advisory council must advise the commissioner 89.21 regarding the appeal. The commissioner's decision to uphold or 89.22 deny an appeal is final. 89.23 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] Subdivisions 1 to 4 are effective 89.24 immediately and apply to the 2005-2006 school year and later. 89.25 Subdivision 5 is effective immediately and applies to the 89.26 2005-2006 school year through the 2013-2014 school year. 89.27 Sec. 10. [120B.363] [TEACHER QUALITY.] 89.28 Subdivision 1. [CLASSROOM TEACHERS.] All teachers teaching 89.29 reading, writing, mathematics, science, social sciences, and 89.30 arts and literature must satisfy the definition of qualified 89.31 teacher under section 122A.16. 89.32 Subd. 2. [PARAPROFESSIONALS.] (a) All paraprofessionals 89.33 working in public schools, except those who provide only 89.34 parental involvement or translation services, must have at least 89.35 a high school diploma or a GED. 89.36 (b) Paraprofessionals who provide instructional services 90.1 must demonstrate their teaching qualifications to meet rigorous 90.2 standards by: 90.3 (1) passing a formal state assessment; 90.4 (2) completing at least two years of postsecondary study 90.5 related to their area of instruction; or 90.6 (3) obtaining at least an associate's degree related to 90.7 their area of instruction. 90.8 (c) Paraprofessionals hired by a school district after 90.9 January 30, 2002, must satisfy the requirements of paragraphs 90.10 (a) and (b) immediately upon employment. Paraprofessionals 90.11 hired by a school district before January 30, 2002, must satisfy 90.12 the requirements of paragraphs (a) and (b) by January 8, 2006. 90.13 Subd. 3. [BOARD OF TEACHING REVIEW OF PRAXIS.] The board 90.14 of teaching must compare Minnesota's current passing criteria 90.15 and scores for the Praxis test against those of other states. 90.16 If the board finds that one or more of Minnesota's passing 90.17 scores is below the scores of at least 25 other states, the 90.18 board must submit a written report by January 3, 2004, to the 90.19 commissioner and the education committees of the legislature 90.20 explaining Minnesota's low passing scores. 90.21 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective immediately. 90.22 To the extent the federal government allows, the commissioner 90.23 may waive for up to six months the teaching qualifications under 90.24 subdivision 2, paragraph (b), applicable to a paraprofessional 90.25 hired after January 30, 2002. 90.26 Sec. 11. [120B.364] [REPORT CARDS.] 90.27 Subdivision 1. [SCHOOL REPORTS.] (a) All public schools 90.28 annually must have an electronic or printed report available 90.29 upon request to parents and the public. The report must include 90.30 at least the following schoolwide information: 90.31 (1) a mean score and the percent of students by grade and 90.32 subject scoring at or above the state's expected level of 90.33 performance on statewide tests, and disaggregated by subgroups 90.34 with ten or more students where subgroups are defined by gender, 90.35 migrant status, limited English proficiency status, special 90.36 education status, ethnicity, and eligibility for free or reduced 91.1 price lunch; 91.2 (2) the number and percent of students tested who scored 91.3 within each of the state's proficiency levels in the school as a 91.4 whole and in each subgroup with ten or more students; 91.5 (3) the percent of students tested in the school as a whole 91.6 and in each subgroup with ten or more students; 91.7 (4) two-year trend data in the mean and percent of students 91.8 tested by grade and subject who meet or exceed the state's 91.9 expectation for achievement; 91.10 (5) after two years of statewide annual testing in grades 3 91.11 through 8 and one grade in high school, the school average 91.12 value-added, grade-to-grade gains in student achievement, 91.13 consistent with section 120B.35 and this section, and the 91.14 percent of students predicted to meet proficiency levels under 91.15 high school graduation or higher education readiness standards, 91.16 or other standards the commissioner designates for reporting 91.17 gain scores; 91.18 (6) the number and percent of teachers teaching in core 91.19 academic areas who are certified in that particular core 91.20 academic area of instruction and the number and percent of 91.21 teachers holding emergency credentials who are teaching in core 91.22 academic areas; 91.23 (7) the average attendance rate by grade; and 91.24 (8) for high schools with ten or more students terminating 91.25 by graduating or dropping out of school under the quasi-cohort 91.26 formula under section 120B.36, subdivision 5, paragraph (b), the 91.27 average graduation rate by grade. 91.28 (b) To permit comparisons, the report also must show, 91.29 alongside the schoolwide means and percents, the same categories 91.30 showing statewide and districtwide means and percents. If the 91.31 school is designated low-performing or unsafe, the report must 91.32 name the school and show the designation, the sanctions imposed 91.33 on the school as a result of the designation, and the actions 91.34 taken to improve the school's performance. If the school is 91.35 designated excellent or superior, the report must name the 91.36 school, show the designation, and describe the achievements and 92.1 exemplary practices on which the designation is based. 92.2 (c) The commissioner must post on the department Web site 92.3 the school information reported under this subdivision. A 92.4 school with a printed report must make copies of the report 92.5 available to public libraries under chapter 134 that are located 92.6 within the district in which the school is located. A school 92.7 must consider the extent of parent and public access to 92.8 electronic media when deciding the form in which to publish the 92.9 report. 92.10 Subd. 2. [DISTRICT REPORTS.] (a) All school districts 92.11 annually must have an electronic or printed report available 92.12 upon request to parents and the public. The report must include 92.13 at least the following districtwide information: 92.14 (1) a mean score and the percent of students by grade and 92.15 subject scoring at or above the state's expected level of 92.16 performance on statewide tests, and disaggregated by subgroups 92.17 with ten or more students where subgroups are defined by gender, 92.18 migrant status, limited English proficiency status, special 92.19 education status, ethnicity, and eligibility for free or reduced 92.20 price lunch; 92.21 (2) the number and percent of students tested who scored 92.22 within each of the state's proficiency levels; 92.23 (3) the percent of students tested in the district as a 92.24 whole and in each subgroup with ten or more students; 92.25 (4) two-year trend data in the mean and percent of students 92.26 tested by grade and subject who meet or exceed the state's 92.27 expectation for achievement; 92.28 (5) after two years of statewide annual testing in grades 3 92.29 through 8 and one grade in high school, the district average 92.30 value-added, grade-to-grade gains in student achievement, 92.31 consistent with section 120B.35 and this section, and the 92.32 percent of students predicted to meet proficiency levels under 92.33 high school graduation or higher education readiness standards, 92.34 or other standards the commissioner designates for reporting 92.35 gain scores; 92.36 (6) the number and percent of teachers teaching in core 93.1 academic areas who are certified in that particular core 93.2 academic area of instruction and the number and percent of 93.3 teachers holding emergency credentials who are teaching in core 93.4 academic areas of English, mathematics, science, social 93.5 sciences, arts and literature, and foreign languages; 93.6 (7) the average attendance rate by grade; and 93.7 (8) for high schools with ten or more students terminating 93.8 by graduating or dropping out of school under the quasi-cohort 93.9 formula under section 120B.36, subdivision 5, paragraph (b), the 93.10 average graduation rate by grade. 93.11 (b) To permit comparisons, the report also must show, 93.12 alongside the districtwide means and percents, the same 93.13 categories showing statewide means and percents. If a school 93.14 within the district is designated low-performing or unsafe, the 93.15 report must name the school and show the designation by school, 93.16 the sanctions imposed on the school as a result of the 93.17 designation, and the actions taken to improve the school's 93.18 performance. If a school within the district is designated 93.19 excellent or superior, the report must name the school, show the 93.20 designation by school, and describe the achievements and 93.21 exemplary practices on which the designation is based. 93.22 (c) The commissioner must post on the department Web site 93.23 the district information reported under this subdivision. A 93.24 district with a printed report must make copies of the report 93.25 available to public libraries under chapter 134 that are located 93.26 within the district. A district must consider the extent of 93.27 parent and public access to electronic media when deciding the 93.28 form in which to publish the report. 93.29 Subd. 3. [DETERMINING WHERE A STUDENT IS ENROLLED FOR 93.30 ACCOUNTABILITY PURPOSES.] (a) For purposes of establishing 93.31 accountability, a student is enrolled in the district or charter 93.32 school that, under the UFARS system, receives payments directly 93.33 from the state for costs related to educating that student, 93.34 except under paragraph (e). A school or district that contracts 93.35 with another school, district, area learning center, or 93.36 alternative learning program to provide education services to a 94.1 student who initially enrolls in the contracting school or 94.2 district, remains accountable for that student. 94.3 (b) A school under this section is any public school 94.4 assigned a unique identification number under the UFARS system. 94.5 (c) An area learning center under this section is any 94.6 public school type 41 to 49 under the UFARS system. 94.7 (d) A student participating in an alternative learning 94.8 program that is located within a larger school is enrolled in 94.9 the larger school, except if the student is participating in an 94.10 alternative learning program located in an area learning center 94.11 under paragraph (c). 94.12 (e) A student is enrolled in the district or charter school 94.13 that provides educational services to the student if a court 94.14 orders a student transfer under chapter 260B. 94.15 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective immediately. 94.16 Sec. 12. [120B.365] [ACCOUNTABILITY ADVISORY COUNCIL.] 94.17 Subdivision 1. [ESTABLISHMENT.] An accountability advisory 94.18 council is established under section 15.059. The advisory 94.19 council is composed of nine members appointed by the 94.20 commissioner from throughout the state with interest and 94.21 experience in education, and must include educators, parents and 94.22 members of the public, and the business community. No council 94.23 member shall be engaged in any activity where a conflict of 94.24 interest may arise. Council members annually must elect a 94.25 council chair from among the council members and no council 94.26 member may serve more than two consecutive years as council 94.27 chair. 94.28 Subd. 2. [DUTIES.] The council shall: 94.29 (1) hear appeals of school and district designations under 94.30 sections 120B.361 and 120B.362; 94.31 (2) identify schools and districts eligible for an 94.32 "excellent" or "superior" designation, consistent with the 94.33 requirements under section 123B.61, subdivisions 3 and 4; and 94.34 (3) make recommendations to the commissioner regarding 94.35 those designations. The commissioner's decision regarding a 94.36 designation is final. 95.1 Subd. 3. [ANNUAL REPORT; RECOMMENDATIONS.] The council 95.2 annually by March 1 must submit to the committees of the 95.3 legislature having jurisdiction over kindergarten through grade 95.4 12 education policy and budget issues a report that summarizes 95.5 the grounds on which schools and school districts submitted 95.6 appeals to the council, the council's recommendations to the 95.7 commissioner regarding the appeals, and the commissioner's 95.8 decision. The report also must list the schools and school 95.9 districts eligible for an "excellent" or "superior" designation, 95.10 the council's recommendations regarding the designations and the 95.11 commissioner's decision. The report must state the basis for 95.12 designating a particular school or district as "excellent" or 95.13 "superior." The council may use the content of the reports to 95.14 recommend to the commissioner changes in the state's educational 95.15 accountability system. The commissioner, in consultation with 95.16 the council, must compile and make available in print or 95.17 electronic media on a biannual basis a list of best practices 95.18 culled from schools and districts designated as "excellent" or 95.19 "superior." The commissioner must assist the council upon 95.20 request. 95.21 Subd. 4. [EXPIRATION.] Notwithstanding section 15.059, 95.22 subdivision 5, the council expires on June 30, 2014. 95.23 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective immediately and 95.24 applies to the 2005-2006 school year and later. 95.25 Sec. 13. [REPEALER.] 95.26 (a) Minnesota Statutes 2002, section 120B.031, is repealed. 95.27 (b) Minnesota Rules, parts 3501.0300; 3501.0310; 3501.0320; 95.28 3501.0330; 3501.0340; 3501.0350; 3501.0370; 3501.0380; 95.29 3501.0390; 3501.0400; 3501.0410; 3501.0420; 3501.0440; 95.30 3501.0441; 3501.0442; 3501.0443; 3501.0444; 3501.0445; 95.31 3501.0446; 3501.0447; 3501.0448; 3501.0449; 3501.0450; 95.32 3501.0460; 3501.0461; 3501.0462; 3501.0463; 3501.0464; 95.33 3501.0465; 3501.0466; 3501.0467; 3501.0468; and 3501.0469, are 95.34 repealed. 95.35 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective for the 95.36 2003-2004 school year and thereafter. 96.1 ARTICLE 8 96.2 COMMISSIONER'S DUTIES 96.3 Section 1. [MINNESOTA'S HIGH EDUCATIONAL STANDARDS.] 96.4 The standards adopted by the commissioner under article 7, 96.5 section 2, paragraph (a), must be identical to the standards 96.6 contained in articles 9 to 18 of this act. 96.7 Sec. 2. [RECOMMENDATIONS ON HIGH EDUCATIONAL STANDARDS.] 96.8 (a) The commissioner of children, families, and learning, 96.9 after consulting with stakeholders under paragraph (b), must 96.10 provide written recommendations to the committees of the 96.11 legislature having jurisdiction over kindergarten through grade 96.12 12 education policy and budget issues by February 1, 2004, that 96.13 indicate: 96.14 (1) a plan to have Minnesota teachers grade constructed 96.15 response questions; 96.16 (2) what cut-scores on high school reading and mathematics 96.17 assessments indicate that remedial instruction in the state's 96.18 two-year higher education institutions is unneeded; 96.19 (3) what modifications or improvements to the statewide 96.20 assessments, standards, and benchmarks in the areas of 96.21 mathematics, science, reading, and writing are needed to reduce 96.22 remedial instruction in the state's higher education 96.23 institutions within two years of high school graduation; 96.24 (4) the extent to which successful district programs 96.25 developed under the profile of learning may be incorporated into 96.26 state standards developed under this act; 96.27 (5) how best to integrate content with application, 96.28 critical reasoning, and higher-order thinking into standards 96.29 developed under this act; 96.30 (6) how to effectively assist teachers in formulating 96.31 curriculum for classroom instruction consistent with standards 96.32 developed under this act; 96.33 (7) how to modify the state assessments and the scoring 96.34 procedures so that the tests are returned to districts within 96.35 four weeks of the test administration, have the tests fulfill 96.36 district diagnostic requirements and the state testing 97.1 requirements, and have the tests include both short answer and 97.2 multiple choice answers; 97.3 (8) how to incorporate economics content standards in 97.4 article 9 of this act into the social sciences learning area; 97.5 and 97.6 (9) a plan to develop statewide tests for the social 97.7 sciences learning area in the subject areas of American history, 97.8 geography, civics, and economics, not including personal finance. 97.9 (b) The commissioner must consult with at least the 97.10 following stakeholders when developing recommendations under 97.11 paragraph (a): 97.12 (1) parents of school-age children and members of the 97.13 public throughout the state; 97.14 (2) teachers throughout the state currently licensed and 97.15 providing instruction in one of the six learning areas under 97.16 Minnesota Statutes, section 120B.0013, and elementary and 97.17 secondary school administrators throughout the state currently 97.18 administrating a school site; 97.19 (3) currently serving members of local school boards and 97.20 charter school boards throughout the state; 97.21 (4) faculty at Minnesota's postsecondary institutions 97.22 providing instruction related to one of the six learning areas; 97.23 (5) representatives of Minnesota's business community; and 97.24 (6) national associations of teachers for the six required 97.25 learning areas. 97.26 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 97.27 following final enactment. 97.28 Sec. 3. [LEGISLATIVE APPROVAL OF PROPOSED RULES 97.29 ESTABLISHING STANDARDS AND EDUCATIONAL ACCOUNTABILITY; INTERIM 97.30 STANDARDS.] 97.31 To fulfill the obligation of the legislature to pursue 97.32 educational excellence for all Minnesota citizens and provide 97.33 educational accountability, the commissioner of children, 97.34 families, and learning must present to the committees of the 97.35 legislature charged with oversight of kindergarten through grade 97.36 12 education policy and kindergarten through grade 12 education 98.1 funding all proposed rules and all proposed amendments to or 98.2 repeals of existing rules under Minnesota Statutes, sections 98.3 120B.0012 and 120B.36. The commissioner may not adopt new rules 98.4 or amend or repeal existing rules under Minnesota Statutes, 98.5 sections 120B.0012 and 120B.36, without specific legislative 98.6 authorization. 98.7 [EFFECTIVE DATE.] This section is effective the day 98.8 following final enactment. 98.9 Sec. 4. [8TH GRADE TESTS.] 98.10 The commissioner shall develop a methodology for using 98.11 portions of the tests in the subject areas of reading and 98.12 mathematics for grade 8 students that meet the accountability 98.13 requirements that are required by federal law and provide the 98.14 opportunity for students to demonstrate that they have met the 98.15 state basic skills high school graduation requirement. The 98.16 commissioner shall also develop procedures for students who do 98.17 not initially meet the state basic skills requirement through 98.18 their scores on the basic skills portions of the test by either 98.19 allowing those students in future years to retake the grade 8 98.20 state tests or by taking a different test that covers basic 98.21 content. 98.22 Sec. 5. [STANDARDS; KEY UNDERSTANDINGS.] 98.23 If necessary, the commissioner may refer to the key 98.24 understandings developed as part of a revision of the profile of 98.25 learning by the mid-continent regional educational laboratory in 98.26 order to provide grade-level banding for the state standards 98.27 adopted under this act. 98.28 ARTICLE 9 98.29 REQUIRED: READING, VIEWING, AND LISTENING 98.30 Section 1. [READING, VIEWING, AND LISTENING - PRIMARY.] 98.31 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand that written and 98.32 spoken words connect to ideas purposefully and that the 98.33 individual must be an active participant in order to comprehend 98.34 essential ideas. 98.35 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 98.36 understanding of: 99.1 (1) grade-appropriate sight words and listening vocabulary, 99.2 including synonyms and antonyms; 99.3 (2) the print conventions of English; 99.4 (3) the various purposes for reading, viewing, and 99.5 listening (for example, for pleasure) to gain or evaluate 99.6 information, or to apply knowledge; 99.7 (4) characters, setting, and sequence of events in fiction 99.8 selections; 99.9 (5) topic, main idea, and supporting details in nonfiction 99.10 selections; and 99.11 (6) reading, viewing, and listening to literary and 99.12 nonfiction selections from a variety of genres (for example, 99.13 folk tale, poetry, drama, realistic fiction, fantasy, 99.14 information books, or biography). 99.15 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 99.16 to: 99.17 (1) make sense of words and comprehend meaning in 99.18 grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction selections by: 99.19 (i) decoding words (for example, through the use of letter 99.20 sounds, blends, diagraphs, diphthongs, and word structures); and 99.21 (ii) integrating cueing systems, including graphophonic, 99.22 structure, and meaning; 99.23 (2) interact with grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction 99.24 selections during the reading, viewing, and listening process by: 99.25 (i) setting a purpose; 99.26 (ii) activating prior knowledge; 99.27 (iii) previewing the selection; 99.28 (iv) monitoring and using self-correction strategies (for 99.29 example, rereading, noticing miscues, searching for cues, and 99.30 asking for help); 99.31 (v) reflecting on the meaning of and responding to text; 99.32 (vi) reading aloud fluently, with expression and accuracy; 99.33 and 99.34 (vii) reading silently; 99.35 (3) understand and interpret fiction and/or nonfiction by: 99.36 (i) making and supporting inferences; and 100.1 (ii) using information from illustrations, charts, graphs, 100.2 and oral and media presentations to enhance comprehension; 100.3 (4) critically read, view, and listen to grade-appropriate 100.4 fiction and nonfiction selections by: 100.5 (i) comparing and contrasting elements (for example, 100.6 characters, settings, ideas, or actions) of one or more 100.7 selections; and 100.8 (ii) formulating questions pertaining to a selection that 100.9 was read, viewed, or heard; and 100.10 (5) apply information in grade-appropriate nonfiction 100.11 selections by using multiple-step instructions to perform an 100.12 action. 100.13 Sec. 2. [READING, VIEWING, AND LISTENING - INTERMEDIATE.] 100.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Go beyond the literal meaning of 100.15 the selection and begin to show more sophisticated 100.16 comprehension, including making inferences, analyzing, reacting 100.17 to, and evaluating fiction and nonfiction selections. 100.18 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 100.19 understanding of: 100.20 (1) grade-appropriate word study, including: 100.21 (i) sight words; and 100.22 (ii) reading and listening vocabulary (for example, 100.23 synonyms, antonyms, homophones, and multiple meaning words); 100.24 (2) text features (for example, chapter titles and 100.25 captions); 100.26 (3) the various purposes for reading, viewing, and 100.27 listening (for example, for pleasure) to gain or evaluate 100.28 information, or to apply knowledge; 100.29 (4) the organizational structure of story plots (for 100.30 example, main problem, conflict, and resolution in fiction); 100.31 (5) the organizational structure of grade-appropriate 100.32 nonfiction selections, including: 100.33 (i) topic, main idea, and details; and 100.34 (ii) compare and contrast, cause and effect, logical, and 100.35 sequential order; 100.36 (6) various genres (for example, fairy tale, mythology, 101.1 folk tale, poetry, fable, fantasy, historical fiction, realistic 101.2 fiction, biography, and autobiography); and 101.3 (7) literary devices used in literary selections (for 101.4 example, personification, alliteration, onomatopoeia, simile, 101.5 metaphor, and imagery). 101.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 101.7 to: 101.8 (1) make sense of words and comprehend meaning in 101.9 grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction selections by: 101.10 (i) decoding words (for example, through the use of vowel 101.11 patterns, complex word families, syllabication, root words, and 101.12 affixes); and 101.13 (ii) using word structure and context; 101.14 (2) interact with grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction 101.15 selections during the reading, viewing, and listening process by: 101.16 (i) setting a purpose; 101.17 (ii) activating prior knowledge; 101.18 (iii) previewing the selection; 101.19 (iv) using specific strategies to clear up confusing parts 101.20 of the text (for example, pausing, rereading, viewing or 101.21 listening to a selection again, consulting another source, 101.22 representing information as a mental picture, drawing upon 101.23 background information, and asking for help); 101.24 (v) reading, viewing, and listening to literary and 101.25 nonfiction selections from a variety of genres and then 101.26 reflecting on the meaning of and responding to the selection; 101.27 and 101.28 (vi) reading narrative and expository text aloud with 101.29 developmentally appropriate fluency, accuracy, pacing, 101.30 intonation, and expression; 101.31 (3) understand and interpret fiction and/or nonfiction by: 101.32 (i) summarizing print and nonprint selections; 101.33 (ii) making inferences and drawing conclusions that are 101.34 supported with information from the selections; and 101.35 (iii) using information from illustrations, charts, graphs, 101.36 maps, media, and oral presentations to enhance comprehension; 102.1 (4) critically read, view, and listen to grade-appropriate 102.2 fiction and/or nonfiction selections by: 102.3 (i) comparing and contrasting information on the same topic 102.4 from different sources; 102.5 (ii) distinguishing fact from opinion; 102.6 (iii) identifying author's purpose; and 102.7 (iv) formulating questions pertaining to a selection that 102.8 was read, heard, or viewed; and 102.9 (5) apply information in grade-appropriate nonfiction 102.10 selections by using multiple-step instructions to perform an 102.11 action. 102.12 Sec. 3. [READING, VIEWING, AND LISTENING TO COMPLEX 102.13 INFORMATION - MIDDLE SCHOOL.] 102.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Make the transition to adult 102.15 reading, listening, and viewing by gaining confidence with more 102.16 difficult and complex fiction, nonfiction, and technical 102.17 selections. 102.18 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 102.19 understanding of: 102.20 (1) grade-appropriate word knowledge in order to read, 102.21 view, or listen to a selection, including general, specific, and 102.22 technical vocabulary; 102.23 (2) text features intended to enhance comprehension in 102.24 print (for example, bold-faced headings, italics, margin notes, 102.25 color, introductions, and conclusions); 102.26 (3) the various purposes for reading, viewing, and 102.27 listening (for example, for pleasure) to gain or evaluate 102.28 information, or to apply knowledge; 102.29 (4) criteria for evaluation of fiction (for example, plot 102.30 and character development, literary merit, thematic development, 102.31 and use of language); 102.32 (5) figurative language, literary devices, and imagery in 102.33 fiction and nonfiction selections; 102.34 (6) various literary and nonfiction genres (for example, 102.35 short stories, novels, poetry, drama, editorials, or essays); 102.36 (7) determining the patterns of organization in fiction 103.1 (for example, genre); nonfiction (for example, compare and 103.2 contrast, cause and effect, topical, and chronological); and 103.3 technical selections; and 103.4 (8) source evaluation, author's qualifications, bias, and 103.5 evidence in nonfiction. 103.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 103.7 to: 103.8 (1) make sense of words in order to comprehend meaning in 103.9 grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction selections by: 103.10 (i) using context clues; derivations (for example, roots, 103.11 prefixes, and suffixes); and word origins; and 103.12 (ii) interpreting figurative language, literary devices, 103.13 and imagery in fiction; 103.14 (2) interact with grade-appropriate fiction and nonfiction 103.15 selections during the reading, viewing, and listening process by: 103.16 (i) setting a purpose, activating prior knowledge, and 103.17 previewing selections; 103.18 (ii) monitoring and clarifying understanding of selections; 103.19 (iii) adjusting rate based on purpose and difficulty in 103.20 text; and 103.21 (iv) identifying transitional words in print and nonprint 103.22 selections; 103.23 (3) comprehend and interpret grade-appropriate fiction, 103.24 nonfiction, and technical selections by: 103.25 (i) paraphrasing events, ideas, or steps in sequence; 103.26 (ii) recognizing and analyzing genres; 103.27 (iii) interpreting ideas not explicitly stated (for 103.28 example, main idea and conclusions); 103.29 (iv) drawing conclusions and making predictions by using 103.30 information or clues in the selection and by using prior 103.31 knowledge, and interpreting presentations of data in selections; 103.32 and 103.33 (v) organizing information to show the hierarchy of ideas 103.34 within selections (for example, through plot lines, timelines, 103.35 flow charts, and task-specific graphic organizers); and 103.36 (4) evaluate elements of fiction in grade-appropriate 104.1 selections according to preestablished criteria while reading, 104.2 viewing, and listening to a variety of genres (for example, 104.3 short story, drama, mythology, folk tales, novels, and fantasy) 104.4 by: 104.5 (i) describing characters and events, interpreting social 104.6 practices, connecting selections with other selections or 104.7 related experiences, critiquing, or judging; 104.8 (ii) reflecting on the meaning of and responding to 104.9 selections; and 104.10 (iii) identifying tone, character development, plot, 104.11 imagery, literary merit, thematic development, and use of 104.12 language; 104.13 (5) critically read, view, and listen to grade-appropriate 104.14 nonfiction or technical selections by: 104.15 (i) contrasting information on the same topic from 104.16 different types of sources; 104.17 (ii) identifying and contrasting information from both 104.18 informative and persuasive selections on the same topic; 104.19 (iii) recognizing stereotyping; 104.20 (iv) identifying source documentation, author, and evidence 104.21 in a selection; 104.22 (v) distinguishing fact from opinion in mixed statements; 104.23 (vi) recognizing persuasion in print and nonprint 104.24 selections; 104.25 (vii) identifying author's purpose and point of view when 104.26 given more than one selection on the same topic; and 104.27 (viii) formulating questions pertaining to a selection that 104.28 was read, viewed, or listened to; and 104.29 (6) apply information in grade-appropriate nonfiction and 104.30 technical selections by: 104.31 (i) following step-by-step directions using appropriate 104.32 tools and procedures; and 104.33 (ii) identifying information in a selection that is needed 104.34 to complete a task or make a decision. 104.35 Sec. 4. [TECHNICAL INFORMATION - HIGH SCHOOL.] 104.36 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Interpret, analyze, apply, and 105.1 evaluate information presented in nonfiction and technical 105.2 selections. 105.3 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 105.4 understanding of: 105.5 (1) grade-appropriate word knowledge in order to read, 105.6 view, and listen to nonfiction and technical selections, 105.7 including, but not limited to, general, specific, and technical 105.8 vocabulary; 105.9 (2) features intended to enhance comprehension in print and 105.10 nonprint selections; 105.11 (3) the various purposes for reading, viewing, and 105.12 listening to nonfiction and technical selections (for example, 105.13 for pleasure) to gain or evaluate information, or to apply 105.14 knowledge; 105.15 (4) transitional and organizing words in print and nonprint 105.16 selections; 105.17 (5) patterns of organization in persuasive nonfiction; 105.18 (6) various nonfiction and technical genres (for example, 105.19 editorials, letters to the editor, contemporary essays, primary 105.20 sources, taped interviews, films, documentaries, or satire); and 105.21 pamphlets, how-to selections, directions, or manuals; 105.22 (7) figurative language, imagery, and literary devices 105.23 while reading, viewing, and listening to nonfiction selections; 105.24 (8) critical evaluation of source, including internal and 105.25 external authority, bias, evidence, purpose, and audience; and 105.26 (9) the logic of reasoning in nonfiction selections. 105.27 Subd. 3. [PART B.] The student shall demonstrate the 105.28 ability to: 105.29 (1) make sense of words and improve comprehension in 105.30 grade-appropriate selections by: 105.31 (i) using strategies, including context clues and 105.32 derivation to acquire grade-appropriate vocabulary; and 105.33 (ii) interpreting figurative language and imagery in 105.34 nonfiction selections, including symbolism, tone, irony, and 105.35 satire; 105.36 (2) interact with grade-appropriate nonfiction and 106.1 technical selections by: 106.2 (i) setting a purpose, activating prior knowledge, and 106.3 previewing selections; 106.4 (ii) monitoring and clarifying understanding of selections; 106.5 (iii) adjusting rate based on purpose and difficulty in 106.6 text; and 106.7 (iv) identifying transitional words in print and nonprint 106.8 selections; 106.9 (3) comprehend and interpret grade-appropriate nonfiction 106.10 and technical selections by: 106.11 (i) restating and summarizing important ideas, events, and 106.12 steps from oral presentations, video, film, or computer data 106.13 manuals (for example, by taking notes, creating structural 106.14 organizers, participating in discussions, or creating an 106.15 abstract, precis, or synopsis); 106.16 (ii) drawing conclusions and making predictions from 106.17 multiple selections on the same topic; 106.18 (iii) interpreting presentations of data in connection with 106.19 other information in selections; 106.20 (iv) differentiating persuasive patterns of organization 106.21 (for example, problem-solution, thesis-evidence, 106.22 opinion-reason); and 106.23 (v) organizing information to clearly show the hierarchy of 106.24 ideas within a selection; 106.25 (4) critically read, view, and listen to grade-appropriate 106.26 nonfiction and technical selections by: 106.27 (i) determining whether the evidence given is appropriate, 106.28 adequate, and accurate; 106.29 (ii) evaluating the credibility and reliability of the 106.30 source; 106.31 (iii) evaluating bias and logic of reasoning; 106.32 (iv) interpreting persuasive print and nonprint selections; 106.33 (v) evaluating author's point of view, intended audience, 106.34 and authority; 106.35 (vi) formulating critical, evaluative questions relevant to 106.36 a selection; and 107.1 (vii) evaluating how the type of communication shapes or 107.2 limits the information; and 107.3 (5) apply information in grade-appropriate nonfiction and 107.4 technical selections by: 107.5 (i) following step-by-step directions, using appropriate 107.6 tools and procedures, to build or assemble, maintain or repair, 107.7 analyze a situation, or create a design; 107.8 (ii) selecting relevant information from electronic media, 107.9 print and nonprint sources, and visual presentations in order to 107.10 determine a course of action; and 107.11 (iii) selecting relevant information from electronic media, 107.12 print and nonprint sources, and visual presentations in order to 107.13 complete an application. 107.14 ARTICLE 10 107.15 REQUIRED: WRITING AND SPEAKING 107.16 Section 1. [WRITING - PRIMARY.] 107.17 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Write effectively for a variety 107.18 of purposes and audiences. 107.19 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 107.20 understanding of the writing process and characteristics of 107.21 effective writing by: 107.22 (1) using prewriting strategies (for example, retelling 107.23 ideas); drawing pictures and webs to generate ideas; or 107.24 discussing ideas with peers; 107.25 (2) drafting and revising written work using strategies 107.26 that include rereading, rearranging words and sentences; varying 107.27 beginnings of sentences and sentence types; adding descriptive 107.28 words and details; and organizing for a beginning, middle, and 107.29 end sequence; 107.30 (3) editing and publishing written work using strategies 107.31 that include editing and proofreading for spelling, 107.32 capitalization, punctuation, grammar, and sentence formation at 107.33 a developmentally appropriate level; and sharing or presenting 107.34 finished products; 107.35 (4) adapting writing for a variety of audiences and 107.36 purposes by creating, for example, picture books; letters; 108.1 poems; or responses to literature; and 108.2 (5) evaluating own and others' writing by, for example, 108.3 asking questions and commenting about writings; recognizing 108.4 conventions and other characteristics of effective writing in 108.5 own and others' work at a developmentally appropriate level; or 108.6 helping others apply conventions and other characteristics of 108.7 effective writing. 108.8 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 108.9 to write for a variety of purposes in a selection of forms 108.10 employing developmentally appropriate conventions by: 108.11 (1) composing a how-to piece that includes directions with 108.12 accurately sequenced multiple steps; task-specific vocabulary; 108.13 illustrations or other visuals; and an incorporated listing of 108.14 necessary materials; 108.15 (2) composing a narrative based on personal experience, 108.16 observation, or imagination that includes details, descriptions, 108.17 and examples to create images; and accurately sequenced ideas or 108.18 events; and 108.19 (3) composing a report describing and giving information 108.20 about a person, object, or a situation that includes a main 108.21 idea; supporting facts or details; and a conclusion. 108.22 Sec. 2. [SPEAKING - PRIMARY.] 108.23 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Speak effectively for a variety 108.24 of purposes. 108.25 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 108.26 understanding of strategies for effective speaking and 108.27 interpersonal communication in developmentally appropriate ways 108.28 by: 108.29 (1) recognizing and following rules of respectful 108.30 conversation; 108.31 (2) making contributions in class and in group discussions; 108.32 (3) adapting voice level, phrasing, intonation, and 108.33 vocabulary for different speaking situations and audiences (for 108.34 example, peers, small groups, or large groups); 108.35 (4) asking and responding to questions; and 108.36 (5) reciting and responding to stories and poems. 109.1 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 109.2 to speak in a variety of situations by: 109.3 (1) giving an informative presentation that includes 109.4 examples to explain the main idea and responses to questions 109.5 from the audience; and 109.6 (2) giving a brief narrative presentation based on 109.7 experience or imagination that includes a context for the 109.8 narrative, details, and appropriately sequenced events. 109.9 Sec. 3. [WRITING - INTERMEDIATE.] 109.10 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Write effectively for a variety 109.11 of purposes and audiences. 109.12 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 109.13 understanding of the writing process and characteristics of 109.14 effective writing by: 109.15 (1) using prewriting strategies (for example, graphic 109.16 organizers, informal interviews, notes, or organizing material 109.17 according to type and purpose of writing); 109.18 (2) drafting and revising of written work using strategies 109.19 that include elaborating on a central idea by using specific 109.20 facts and details; developing multiple paragraphs connected by 109.21 transitional words and devices; employing dialogue, description, 109.22 exposition, and reflection when appropriate; and varying 109.23 sentence type and length; 109.24 (3) editing and publishing written work using strategies 109.25 that include editing and proofreading for spelling, 109.26 capitalization, punctuation, grammar, and paragraphing at a 109.27 developmentally appropriate level; incorporating photos, 109.28 illustrations, charts, or graphs when needed; and using 109.29 appropriate available technology to edit and publish work; 109.30 (4) adapting writing for a variety of audiences and 109.31 purposes by creating, for example, biographies; stories; writing 109.32 to demonstrate learning in various content areas; or learning 109.33 logs or journals; and 109.34 (5) evaluating own and others' writing by, for example, 109.35 determining best features of a piece of writing; asking for 109.36 feedback during writing process; responding to others' writing; 110.1 or using preset criteria to judge quality of pieces of writing. 110.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 110.3 to write for a variety of purposes in a selection of forms 110.4 employing developmentally appropriate conventions by: 110.5 (1) composing a piece using a problem-solution organization 110.6 that includes explaining a problem or conflict using details and 110.7 evidence; and presenting a possible solution or resolution to 110.8 the problem or conflict using details and evidence; 110.9 (2) composing a description of a real or imagined person, 110.10 place, object, incident, or process that includes a clear 110.11 organizational structure; and details and descriptive words that 110.12 create images; 110.13 (3) composing a narrative based on direct experience, 110.14 observation, or imagination that includes a flow of action with 110.15 a beginning, middle, and end; a description of setting and 110.16 character using details; and dialogue when appropriate; and 110.17 (4) composing an expository piece that includes an 110.18 explanation of or an assertion about a topic starting with a 110.19 main idea, facts, details, and examples to develop the topic; 110.20 and a conclusion. 110.21 Sec. 4. [SPEAKING - INTERMEDIATE.] 110.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Speak effectively for a variety 110.23 of purposes. 110.24 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 110.25 understanding of strategies of effective speaking and 110.26 interpersonal communication in developmentally appropriate ways 110.27 by: 110.28 (1) respecting individual differences; 110.29 (2) using a variety of verbal and nonverbal communication 110.30 skills in formal and informal speaking situations; 110.31 (3) contributing to class and group discussions; 110.32 (4) conveying a clear main point when speaking formally; 110.33 (5) asking and responding to questions and comments; 110.34 (6) responding to fiction and nonfiction selections; and 110.35 (7) adapting voice level, phrasing, intonation, and 110.36 vocabulary for different speaking situations and audiences. 111.1 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 111.2 to speak in a variety of situations by: 111.3 (1) planning and carrying out an event in a small group 111.4 that includes constructing and implementing a group work plan; 111.5 showing respect and empathy in a variety of cooperative group 111.6 roles; and obtaining, organizing, and sharing materials; and 111.7 (2) preparing and presenting a demonstration that includes 111.8 a description of a step-by-step procedure; use of visuals to 111.9 illustrate ideas; use effective delivery techniques; and 111.10 responses to questions from the audience. 111.11 Sec. 5. [WRITING - MIDDLE.] 111.12 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Write effectively for a variety 111.13 of purposes and audiences. 111.14 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 111.15 understanding of the writing process and characteristics of 111.16 effective writing by: 111.17 (1) using prewriting strategies (for example, making plans 111.18 or outlines that consider audience and purpose); building 111.19 background knowledge; using writing models; freewriting; or 111.20 generating criteria for quality writing; 111.21 (2) drafting and revising written work using strategies 111.22 that include using an organizational scheme; using transitional 111.23 devices between ideas and paragraphs, including sensory details 111.24 and figurative language when needed; elaborating on a main idea 111.25 by using specific facts and details; and revising for word 111.26 choice, sentence fluency, and voice; 111.27 (3) editing and publishing written work using strategies 111.28 that include editing and proofreading for spelling, punctuation, 111.29 grammar, and paragraphing at a developmentally appropriate 111.30 level; and using appropriate available technology to edit and 111.31 publish written work; 111.32 (4) adapting writing for a variety of audiences and 111.33 purposes by creating, for example, autobiographies; dramas; 111.34 on-demand writing for tests and other projects; and 111.35 investigative reports; and 111.36 (5) evaluating own and others' writing by, for example, 112.1 applying criteria generated by self and others; self-reflecting 112.2 on strengths and weaknesses as a writer; or responding to 112.3 others' writing. 112.4 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 112.5 to write for a variety of purposes in a selection of forms 112.6 employing developmentally appropriate conventions by: 112.7 (1) composing technical writing or directions that include 112.8 formatting to support the text using, for example, 112.9 illustrations, diagrams, charts, technical drawings, bullets, 112.10 numbers, or outlines; a glossary of technical terms used in the 112.11 text; and word choice and voice appropriate for intended 112.12 audience; 112.13 (2) composing a narrative that includes a description of 112.14 events from direct experience, observation, research, or 112.15 imagination; relevant detail and figurative language to create 112.16 an image of setting, character, events, and ideas; dialogue when 112.17 appropriate; and a logical sequence of events or ideas; 112.18 (3) composing an expository piece that gives an explanation 112.19 of or makes an assertion about a topic starting with a main 112.20 idea; develops the topic with facts, details, and examples; and 112.21 provides a conclusion; and 112.22 (4) composing an idea or opinion piece that summarizes the 112.23 central facts and opinions surrounding an issue with examples 112.24 from more than one source; describes the impact of the issue on 112.25 events or situations; and selects and defends a position based 112.26 on information and reasoning. 112.27 Sec. 6. [SPEAKING - MIDDLE.] 112.28 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Speak effectively for a variety 112.29 of purposes. 112.30 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 112.31 understanding of strategies for effective speaking by: 112.32 (1) participating in a variety of roles in group 112.33 discussions and activities; 112.34 (2) using appropriate verbal and nonverbal skills for oral 112.35 presentations; 112.36 (3) conveying and maintaining a clear main point in 113.1 presentations and discussions; 113.2 (4) asking relevant questions to seek elaboration and 113.3 clarification of ideas; and 113.4 (5) adapting speaking style, format, and vocabulary to 113.5 effectively communicate for a variety of situations and 113.6 audiences. 113.7 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 113.8 to speak in a variety of situations by: 113.9 (1) working with a small group of people to respond to a 113.10 problem, settle a dispute, or create and carry out a plan of 113.11 action for a selected issue that includes interacting and 113.12 communicating appropriately with individuals of different 113.13 genders, cultures, and points of view; adjusting communication 113.14 on the basis of verbal and nonverbal feedback; and expressing 113.15 tone and using vocabulary appropriate for a given situation or 113.16 audience; and 113.17 (2) presenting an idea, opinion, or narrative that includes 113.18 selected information and supporting materials and visuals to 113.19 support the message when appropriate; appropriate verbal and 113.20 nonverbal strategies to communicate the message; reasons and 113.21 examples to support the main point of the presentation; and 113.22 adjusting communication on the basis of verbal and nonverbal 113.23 feedback. 113.24 Sec. 7. [WRITING - HIGH SCHOOL.] 113.25 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Write effectively for a variety 113.26 of purposes and audiences. 113.27 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 113.28 understanding of the writing process and characteristics of 113.29 effective writing by: 113.30 (1) using prewriting strategies (for example, making 113.31 writing plans or outlines that consider audience and purpose); 113.32 employing a variety of techniques to generate ideas; or 113.33 generating criteria for quality writing; 113.34 (2) drafting and revising written work using strategies 113.35 that include rethinking content and organization; checking 113.36 accuracy and idea development; and analyzing and revising for 114.1 voice that is engaging and appropriate for audience and purpose; 114.2 (3) editing and publishing written work using strategies 114.3 that include editing and proofreading for accuracy of 114.4 conventions of language and usage; refining selected pieces to 114.5 share with general or specific audiences; and using appropriate 114.6 available technology to compose, edit, present, or publish 114.7 written work; 114.8 (4) adapting writing for a variety of audiences and 114.9 purposes by creating, for example, expositions that analyze, 114.10 synthesize, and organize information from primary and secondary 114.11 sources; reflective compositions; personal and business 114.12 correspondence; or writing for various media (print, Internet, 114.13 television, radio); and 114.14 (5) evaluating own and others' writing by, for example, 114.15 determining strengths and weaknesses as a writer based on a body 114.16 of written work; using formal and self-designed sets of criteria 114.17 to evaluate own and others' writing; responding productively to 114.18 reviews of own work; or using self-assessment techniques to set 114.19 and achieve goals as a writer. 114.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 114.21 to write for a variety of purposes in a selection of forms 114.22 employing appropriate conventions of language and usage by: 114.23 (1) composing a piece that describes, narrates, or explains 114.24 observations of human events or situations; 114.25 (2) composing a piece that analyzes patterns or 114.26 relationships of ideas, topics, or themes; 114.27 (3) composing a piece that constructs support for a 114.28 position, argument, plan, or idea; and 114.29 (4) composing a piece that evaluates an idea, topic, or 114.30 theme based on expressed criteria. 114.31 Sec. 8. [TECHNICAL WRITING - HIGH SCHOOL.] 114.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Write effectively for a variety 114.33 of technical purposes and audiences. 114.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 114.35 understanding of the writing process and characteristics of 114.36 effective technical writing by: 115.1 (1) using prewriting strategies (for example, making 115.2 writing plans or outlines that consider audience, purpose, and 115.3 options for format); employing a variety of techniques to 115.4 generate ideas; or identifying criteria for quality technical 115.5 writing; 115.6 (2) drafting and revising written work using strategies 115.7 that include drafting and revising for clarity and accuracy of 115.8 content; incorporating detailed examples or illustrations when 115.9 needed; organizing text and selecting vocabulary appropriate to 115.10 topic and audience; and writing and reworking for precise 115.11 language that meets the reader's needs, including warnings or 115.12 cautions as necessary to help the reader prevent errors; 115.13 (3) editing and publishing written work using strategies 115.14 that include editing and proofreading for accuracy of 115.15 conventions of language and usage; and using appropriate 115.16 available technology to compose, edit, present, or publish 115.17 written work; 115.18 (4) adapting writing for a variety of audiences and 115.19 purposes by creating, for example, expositions that analyze, 115.20 synthesize, and organize information from primary and secondary 115.21 sources; and 115.22 (5) evaluating own and others' writing by, for example, 115.23 using formal and self-designed sets of criteria to evaluate own 115.24 and others' writing; checking accuracy of technical writings 115.25 with expert readers or sample documents; or using 115.26 self-assessment techniques to set and achieve goals as a writer. 115.27 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 115.28 to write for a variety of technical purposes in a selection of 115.29 forms employing appropriate conventions of language and usage by: 115.30 (1) composing a set of directions describing how to 115.31 complete, engage in, or operate a complex process, procedure, or 115.32 device; 115.33 (2) composing descriptive materials about a product, place, 115.34 organization, or system; 115.35 (3) composing a report, proposal, or application 115.36 incorporating a body of technical knowledge and suggesting a 116.1 course of action; and 116.2 (4) composing a series of technical correspondences 116.3 explaining or analyzing complex processes, situations, or 116.4 devices. 116.5 Sec. 9. [PUBLIC SPEAKING - HIGH SCHOOL.] 116.6 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Speak effectively for a variety 116.7 of purposes. 116.8 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 116.9 understanding of strategies for effective public speaking by: 116.10 (1) determining the intent of the message; 116.11 (2) using a variety of planning procedures and 116.12 organizational structures; 116.13 (3) adjusting style, message, and delivery as appropriate 116.14 for particular purposes and audiences; 116.15 (4) using appropriate visuals, technology, or other 116.16 equipment; 116.17 (5) using a variety of verbal and nonverbal delivery 116.18 techniques; 116.19 (6) adjusting presentation based on verbal and nonverbal 116.20 feedback; and 116.21 (7) using criteria to evaluate own and others' 116.22 effectiveness in presentations. 116.23 Subd. 3. [PART B.] The student shall demonstrate the 116.24 ability to speak in a variety of situations, including: 116.25 (1) constructing and delivering an informative 116.26 presentation; and 116.27 (2) constructing and delivering a persuasive presentation. 116.28 Sec. 10. [INTERPERSONAL COMMUNICATION - HIGH SCHOOL; 116.29 OPTIONAL.] 116.30 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Communicate effectively in a 116.31 variety of interpersonal situations. 116.32 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 116.33 understanding of strategies for effective interpersonal 116.34 communication by: 116.35 (1) showing respect and empathy for individual differences 116.36 and feelings by adjusting verbal and nonverbal language as 117.1 needed; 117.2 (2) using appropriate language conventions in varied 117.3 interpersonal situations; 117.4 (3) using problem-solving skills of conciliation, 117.5 mediation, or negotiation to improve communication; 117.6 (4) utilizing active listening and feedback in group 117.7 activities; and 117.8 (5) using criteria to evaluate own and others' 117.9 effectiveness in group discussions and other interpersonal 117.10 contexts. 117.11 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate an ability 117.12 to communicate in a variety of interpersonal situations, 117.13 including: 117.14 (1) playing an active role in a group activity leading to a 117.15 presentation on a selected topic using available technology when 117.16 appropriate; and 117.17 (2) playing an active role in a group planning and 117.18 implementing an event or an ongoing program using available 117.19 technology when appropriate. 117.20 ARTICLE 11 117.21 REQUIRED: MATHEMATICAL CONCEPTS AND APPLICATIONS 117.22 Section 1. [SHAPE, SPACE, AND MEASUREMENT - PRIMARY.] 117.23 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Explore three-dimensional 117.24 objects and later, their two-dimensional faces, with a focus on 117.25 developing shape, location, and measurement concepts. 117.26 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 117.27 understanding of: 117.28 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 117.29 (i) patterns as either repeating or growing; 117.30 (ii) two-dimensional shapes as the images or footprints of 117.31 three-dimensional shapes; and 117.32 (iii) names and attributes of different shapes; and 117.33 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 117.34 (i) measurement as the number of repetitions of a single 117.35 unit; and 117.36 (ii) measurement attributes of length, volume, weight, 118.1 area, and time. 118.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 118.3 to: 118.4 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 118.5 (i) describe, represent, and extend existing visual 118.6 patterns, and create new patterns; 118.7 (ii) recognize shapes in real-world contexts; 118.8 (iii) sort and classify shapes by their familiar 118.9 attributes; 118.10 (iv) model familiar two- and three-dimensional shapes by 118.11 building or drawing them; 118.12 (v) recognize and create shapes that have symmetry; and 118.13 (vi) describe and compare the location or position of 118.14 objects using common terms; and 118.15 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 118.16 (i) predict what happens to an object as a result of 118.17 flipping, sliding, and turning; 118.18 (ii) use measurement to order a group of objects; 118.19 (iii) use nonstandard units and later, standard whole 118.20 units, to measure familiar objects; and 118.21 (iv) develop measurement benchmarks for making comparisons 118.22 and estimates. 118.23 Sec. 2. [NUMBER SENSE - PRIMARY.] 118.24 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use whole number concepts, 118.25 relationships, and operations to represent information, solve 118.26 problems, and justify reasoning. 118.27 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 118.28 understanding of: 118.29 (1) multiple models of place value and the base-ten number 118.30 system; 118.31 (2) relative position and magnitude of whole numbers; 118.32 (3) various approaches to addition and subtraction of whole 118.33 numbers and the relationship between the two operations; and 118.34 (4) situations that suggest multiplication and division 118.35 (for example, equal groupings of objects and sharing equally). 118.36 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 119.1 to: 119.2 (1) represent and use whole numbers in flexible ways, 119.3 including composing and decomposing tens, hundreds, and 119.4 thousands; 119.5 (2) develop and use strategies for whole-number 119.6 computations, with a focus on addition and subtraction; 119.7 (3) develop and use strategies for estimating, comparing, 119.8 and ordering whole numbers; 119.9 (4) use a variety of methods and tools to compute, 119.10 including objects, mental computation, estimation, paper and 119.11 pencil, and calculators; 119.12 (5) use whole numbers to identify, describe, and predict 119.13 both repeating and growing patterns; 119.14 (6) organize and represent data using concrete objects, 119.15 pictures, and graphs; and 119.16 (7) represent commonly used fractions, including 119.17 one-fourth, one-third, and one-half. 119.18 Sec. 3. [SHAPE, SPACE, AND MEASUREMENT - INTERMEDIATE.] 119.19 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate, visualize, and 119.20 classify two- and three-dimensional shapes and their attributes 119.21 with a focus on developing geometric vocabulary and applying 119.22 standard units of measure. 119.23 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student will demonstrate an 119.24 understanding of: 119.25 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] Geometric attributes and 119.26 properties, including parallel, perpendicular, vertices, edges, 119.27 faces, length, area, and congruency; and 119.28 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 119.29 (i) standard units in the metric and customary systems; and 119.30 (ii) geometric vocabulary used to describe location, 119.31 movement, and direction. 119.32 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student will demonstrate the ability 119.33 to: 119.34 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 119.35 (i) use mathematical language to explain the structure of a 119.36 geometric pattern; 120.1 (ii) translate between a three-dimensional object and its 120.2 two-dimensional representation; 120.3 (iii) classify two- and three-dimensional shapes according 120.4 to their properties and develop definitions of classes of shapes 120.5 (for example, triangles and pyramids); and 120.6 (iv) reason about the results of transforming shapes, 120.7 including flipping, sliding, and turning; and 120.8 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 120.9 (i) use maps or graphs to determine distances and efficient 120.10 routes; 120.11 (ii) estimate measurements by using appropriate units and 120.12 comparisons to known objects or quantities; 120.13 (iii) measure attributes of familiar objects using 120.14 appropriate metric and customary whole and partial units; and 120.15 (iv) select and apply appropriate standard units and tools 120.16 to measure length, area, volume, weight, elapsed time, 120.17 temperature, and the size of angles. 120.18 Sec. 4. [NUMBER SENSE - INTERMEDIATE.] 120.19 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use numbers, language, and 120.20 symbols to represent information, solve problems, and justify 120.21 reasoning. 120.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 120.23 understanding of: 120.24 (1) the place-value structure of the base-ten number 120.25 system; 120.26 (2) various meanings of and approaches to multiplication 120.27 and division of whole numbers; 120.28 (3) the effects of multiplying and dividing whole numbers; 120.29 and 120.30 (4) fractions as parts of unit wholes, as parts of a 120.31 collection, as locations on number lines, and as divisions of 120.32 whole numbers. 120.33 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 120.34 to: 120.35 (1) represent, order, and compare whole numbers and 120.36 decimals; 121.1 (2) fluently add, subtract, multiply, and divide whole 121.2 numbers; 121.3 (3) develop and use strategies to estimate the results of 121.4 whole number computations and to judge the reasonableness of 121.5 such results; 121.6 (4) select and use appropriate methods and tools for 121.7 computing with whole numbers from among mental computation, 121.8 estimation, calculators, and paper and pencil according to the 121.9 context and nature of the problem; 121.10 (5) model problem situations with objects and use 121.11 representations, including tables, graphs, and equations to draw 121.12 conclusions; 121.13 (6) describe and extend patterns, make generalizations, and 121.14 draw conclusions about them; and 121.15 (7) solve a variety of single- and multiple-step problems 121.16 using number relationships and properties, number patterns, and 121.17 computation and estimation strategies. 121.18 Sec. 5. [CHANCE AND DATA - INTERMEDIATE.] 121.19 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Describe and compare the 121.20 likelihood of events, and collect, organize, and represent data 121.21 to answer questions. 121.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 121.23 understanding of: 121.24 (1) [DATA.] Measures of center, focusing on the median; 121.25 and 121.26 (2) [CHANCE.] 121.27 (i) data representations, including line plots, bar graphs, 121.28 and line graphs; and 121.29 (ii) terms used to convey that some events are certain to 121.30 occur, others are certain not to occur, and others may or may 121.31 not occur. 121.32 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 121.33 to: 121.34 (1) [DATA.] 121.35 (i) design an investigation to address a question; 121.36 (ii) collect data using observations, surveys, and 122.1 experiments; 122.2 (iii) organize and represent data using tables and graphs; 122.3 (iv) propose and justify conclusions and predictions based 122.4 on data; 122.5 (v) describe the shape and important features of a set or 122.6 data, and compare related data sets with an emphasis on how the 122.7 data are distributed; and 122.8 (vi) compare different representations of the same data and 122.9 evaluate how well each representation shows important aspects of 122.10 data; and 122.11 (2) [CHANCE.] 122.12 (i) determine the degree of likelihood of an event using 122.13 terminology (for example, certain, likely, equally likely, 122.14 unlikely, and impossible); and 122.15 (ii) predict the probability of an outcome of a simple 122.16 experiment and test the prediction. 122.17 Sec. 6. [SHAPE, SPACE, AND MEASUREMENT - MIDDLE SCHOOL.] 122.18 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use concepts of shape and 122.19 measurement as analytical tools by developing definitions, 122.20 testing conjectures, and applying measurement and proportional 122.21 reasoning skills. 122.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 122.23 understanding of: 122.24 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 122.25 (i) basic concepts of coordinate systems; and 122.26 (ii) precise mathematical names and properties of two- and 122.27 three-dimensional shapes; and 122.28 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] The relationships among units and 122.29 conversion from one measurement unit to another within the same 122.30 system. 122.31 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 122.32 to: 122.33 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 122.34 (i) precisely describe, classify, and understand 122.35 relationships among types of two- and three-dimensional objects 122.36 using their defining properties (for example, angle size, number 123.1 of sides or vertices, parallel faces, and congruent sides); 123.2 (ii) describe the shape, size, position, and orientation of 123.3 geometric figures under informal transformations, including 123.4 flips, turns, slides, and scaling; 123.5 (iii) analyze and describe shapes, symmetries, and tilings 123.6 in art forms from various cultures; 123.7 (iv) apply geometric concepts and relationships to test 123.8 conjectures and solve problems involving congruence, similarity, 123.9 the Pythagorean Theorem, and coordinate systems; and 123.10 (v) use visual tools (for example, networks or vertex-edge 123.11 graphs) to model and solve problems; and 123.12 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 123.13 (i) understand, select, and use units of appropriate size 123.14 and type to measure angles, perimeter, area, surface area, and 123.15 volume; 123.16 (ii) select and apply techniques and tools to accurately 123.17 find length, area, surface area, volume, and angle measures to 123.18 appropriate levels of precision; 123.19 (iii) develop and use formulas to determine the 123.20 circumference of circles and the area of triangles, 123.21 quadrilaterals, and circles; and 123.22 (iv) apply a scale factor to the linear dimensions of a 123.23 shape and describe the resulting changes to the shape's angles, 123.24 perimeter, area, and volume. 123.25 Sec. 7. [NUMBER SENSE - MIDDLE SCHOOL.] 123.26 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use rational number concepts, 123.27 relationships, and computational methods to represent 123.28 information, solve problems, and justify reasoning. 123.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 123.30 understanding of: 123.31 (1) number concepts, including place value, prime and 123.32 composite numbers, and multiples and factors; 123.33 (2) ways of representing fractions, decimals, percents, and 123.34 integers; 123.35 (3) the meaning and effects of arithmetic operations with 123.36 fractions, decimals, and integers; 124.1 (4) exponential, scientific, and calculator notation to 124.2 represent large and small numbers; and 124.3 (5) the inverse relationships of addition and subtraction, 124.4 multiplication and division, and squaring and finding square 124.5 roots. 124.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 124.7 to: 124.8 (1) compare and order fractions, decimals, percents, and 124.9 integers, and translate among equivalent representations of 124.10 numbers; 124.11 (2) fluently add, subtract, and multiply using fractions, 124.12 decimals, and integers; 124.13 (3) use the inverse relationships of addition and 124.14 subtraction, multiplication and division, and squaring and 124.15 finding square roots to simplify computations, and solve 124.16 problems; 124.17 (4) solve a variety of problems by representing rational 124.18 numbers efficiently, selecting and using appropriate operations 124.19 and methods to estimate or compute, and generating and 124.20 describing more than one solution method; 124.21 (5) use factors, multiples, prime factorization, and 124.22 relatively prime numbers to solve problems; and 124.23 (6) apply proportional reasoning to solve a variety of 124.24 problems using rates, ratios, proportions, and percents. 124.25 Sec. 8. [CHANCE AND DATA - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 124.26 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use rational numbers to quantify 124.27 probabilities and use data analysis to answer questions and make 124.28 predictions. 124.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 124.30 understanding of: 124.31 (1) [DATA.] 124.32 (i) measures of center, focusing on the mean; 124.33 (ii) measures of spread, focusing on the interquartile 124.34 range; and 124.35 (iii) graphs of data, including histograms, stem-and-leaf 124.36 plots, box plots, scatterplots, and circle graphs; and 125.1 (2) [CHANCE.] 125.2 (i) probability terminology, including randomness, event, 125.3 sample space, and outcome; and 125.4 (ii) how the likelihood of an event can be expressed using 125.5 a number from zero to one. 125.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 125.7 to: 125.8 (1) [DATA.] 125.9 (i) formulate a question, design a study, and collect data 125.10 to answer the question; 125.11 (ii) select, create, and use appropriate graphical 125.12 representations of data; 125.13 (iii) find, use, and interpret measures of center and 125.14 spread; 125.15 (iv) identify trends in data collected over time and 125.16 differences across various populations; and 125.17 (v) summarize or critique data investigations done by 125.18 others; and 125.19 (2) [CHANCE.] 125.20 (i) use strategies to determine the outcome of a chance 125.21 event, including organized lists, tree diagrams, and area 125.22 models; 125.23 (ii) conduct a probability experiment to simulate a real 125.24 life issue involving uncertainty; and 125.25 (iii) use the results of a probability simulation to make a 125.26 prediction, recommendation, or decision. 125.27 Sec. 9. [ALGEBRA - MIDDLE SCHOOL.] 125.28 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Analyze mathematical patterns, 125.29 relationships, and functions to model and solve problems. 125.30 Subd. 2. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate an 125.31 understanding of: 125.32 (1) patterns, relations, and functions; 125.33 (2) how verbal descriptions, tables, graphs, and equations 125.34 can be used to describe patterns of change in real-world 125.35 situations; 125.36 (3) the similarities and differences between the properties 126.1 of linear and nonlinear functions; and 126.2 (4) equivalent forms for simple algebraic expressions. 126.3 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 126.4 to: 126.5 (1) recognize, analyze, and generalize patterns and build 126.6 mathematical models to make decisions or formulate predictions; 126.7 (2) predict patterns of change in real-world situations 126.8 using verbal descriptions, tables, graphs, and equations; 126.9 (3) classify linear, exponential, and quadratic functions 126.10 and contrast their properties using tables, graphs, and 126.11 equations; 126.12 (4) recognize relationships between symbolic expressions 126.13 and graphs of lines, paying particular attention to the meaning 126.14 of intercept and slope; 126.15 (5) generate equivalent forms for simple algebraic 126.16 expressions and solve multiple step linear equations; and 126.17 (6) use graphing calculator technology to determine 126.18 solutions to linear, exponential, and quadratic equations. 126.19 Sec. 10. [SHAPE, SPACE, AND MEASUREMENT - HIGH SCHOOL.] 126.20 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Develop capacity to reason about 126.21 space, shape, and measurement in increasingly abstract ways. 126.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 126.23 understanding of: 126.24 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 126.25 (i) reflections, rotations, translations, and scaling of 126.26 two-dimensional figures; and 126.27 (ii) congruence and similarity; and 126.28 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 126.29 (i) perimeter, area, surface area, and volume; and 126.30 (ii) distance on a coordinate plane. 126.31 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 126.32 to: 126.33 (1) [SHAPE AND SPACE.] 126.34 (i) use visualization, spatial reasoning, and geometric 126.35 modeling to solve problems; 126.36 (ii) construct and model two- and three-dimensional figures 127.1 from various points of view using appropriate tools and 127.2 technologies (for example, ruler, protractor, interactive 127.3 geometric software, isometric drawing paper, and computer-aided 127.4 design); 127.5 (iii) analyze characteristics of shape, size, and space as 127.6 used in art, architecture, design, or nature; 127.7 (iv) use geometric models to represent and explain 127.8 numerical relationships or measurement problems; 127.9 (v) investigate conjectures and solve problems involving 127.10 two- and three-dimensional objects represented with Cartesian 127.11 coordinates; and 127.12 (vi) make and test conjectures, and solve problems 127.13 involving the congruence and similarity of two-dimensional 127.14 figures; and 127.15 (2) [MEASUREMENT.] 127.16 (i) analyze precision, accuracy, and approximate error in 127.17 measurement situations; and 127.18 (ii) generalize a scale factor to the dimensions of a shape 127.19 and describe the resulting changes to the shape's perimeter, 127.20 area, surface area, and volume. 127.21 Sec. 11. [CHANCE AND DATA - HIGH SCHOOL.] 127.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply concepts of chance and 127.23 data analysis to make critical judgments, predictions, or 127.24 decisions. 127.25 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 127.26 understanding of: 127.27 (1) [DATA.] 127.28 (i) differences among various kinds of statistical studies 127.29 and which inferences can legitimately be drawn from each; 127.30 (ii) the difference between correlation and causation; and 127.31 (iii) characteristics of a well-designed study, including 127.32 the role of randomization, appropriateness of data analysis, and 127.33 validity of conclusions; and 127.34 (2) [CHANCE.] 127.35 (i) how to compute the probability of a compound event; 127.36 (ii) concepts of conditional probability and independent 128.1 events; and 128.2 (iii) concepts of sample space and probability distribution 128.3 for simple cases. 128.4 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 128.5 to: 128.6 (1) [DATA.] 128.7 (i) independently formulate a question, design a study, 128.8 collect data, and report results and conclusions using 128.9 technology, data displays, and statistical measures; 128.10 (ii) evaluate a published report containing data by 128.11 examining the design of the study, the appropriateness of data 128.12 analysis, and the validity of conclusions; 128.13 (iii) display bivariate data using a scatterplot and 128.14 describe the shape of the data; and 128.15 (iv) analyze data by applying tools to find the line or 128.16 curve of best fit and appropriate summary statistics (for 128.17 example, correlation coefficient or regression equation) to make 128.18 decisions; and 128.19 (2) [CHANCE.] 128.20 (i) compute the probability of a compound event using both 128.21 theoretical and experimental probability; 128.22 (ii) compute and interpret the expected value of a random 128.23 variable in simple cases; 128.24 (iii) use sample spaces and probability distributions to 128.25 determine the probability of events in simple cases; and 128.26 (iv) use simulations to construct empirical probability 128.27 distributions. 128.28 Sec. 12. [ALGEBRA - HIGH SCHOOL.] 128.29 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Represent and analyze 128.30 quantitative situations using classes of functions, rates of 128.31 change, and algebraic symbols and processes. 128.32 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 128.33 understanding of: 128.34 (1) relations and functions; 128.35 (2) properties of classes of functions, including 128.36 exponential, polynomial, and periodic functions; and 129.1 (3) equivalent forms of expressions, equations, 129.2 inequalities, and relations. 129.3 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 129.4 to: 129.5 (1) approximate and interpret rates of change from 129.6 graphical and numerical data; 129.7 (2) analyze functions of two variables by investigating 129.8 rates of change, intercepts, zeros, and asymptotes; 129.9 (3) identify essential quantitative relationships in a 129.10 situation and determine the class or classes of functions that 129.11 might model the relationships; 129.12 (4) represent and explain mathematical relationships with 129.13 graphs, tables, spreadsheets, and equations, using both 129.14 technology and paper and pencil; 129.15 (5) fluently use multiple representations of a given 129.16 mathematical relationship; 129.17 (6) use matrices to represent data and solve systems of 129.18 equations; 129.19 (7) generalize patterns and build mathematical models to 129.20 describe and analyze real situations, including linear, 129.21 exponential, and periodic; and 129.22 (8) solve equations, inequalities, and systems of equations 129.23 with fluency (mentally or with paper and pencil in simple cases 129.24 and using technology in all cases) and justify the solutions. 129.25 Sec. 13. [DISCRETE MATHEMATICS - HIGH SCHOOL; OPTIONAL.] 129.26 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use discrete structures to 129.27 represent, model, and interpret physical, social, and 129.28 mathematical phenomena. 129.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 129.30 understanding of counting techniques, including the 129.31 multiplication principle, permutations, and combinations. 129.32 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 129.33 to: 129.34 (1) investigate and apply systematic counting techniques, 129.35 set relationships, and principles of logic to represent, 129.36 analyze, and solve problems; 130.1 (2) use charts, vertex-edge graphs, and matrices to model 130.2 and solve problems and draw reasonable conclusions about the 130.3 situation being modeled; 130.4 (3) explore, develop, and analyze algorithmic thinking to 130.5 accomplish a task or solve a problem; 130.6 (4) use symbolic expressions, including iterative and 130.7 recursive forms to represent relationships arising from various 130.8 contexts; and 130.9 (5) how to generalize patterns using explicitly and 130.10 recursively defined functions. 130.11 Sec. 14. [TECHNICAL APPLICATIONS - HIGH SCHOOL; OPTIONAL.] 130.12 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply mathematics to solve 130.13 technical problems. 130.14 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 130.15 understanding of: 130.16 (1) computational technologies; 130.17 (2) scientific and exponential notation used in complex 130.18 systems; 130.19 (3) trigonometric applications appropriate to technical 130.20 situations; and 130.21 (4) fundamental geometric constructions or calculations 130.22 used in drafting or construction. 130.23 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 130.24 to: 130.25 (1) use complex measurement equipment for several systems; 130.26 (2) convert between measuring systems; 130.27 (3) measure to scale; 130.28 (4) calculate quantities using algebraic formulas; 130.29 (5) read and interpret information in complex graphs, 130.30 tables, and charts; 130.31 (6) create a set of plans to design or modify a complex 130.32 structure, product, or system by researching background 130.33 information, calculating mathematical specifications, and 130.34 developing a materials list that matches mathematical 130.35 specifications; 130.36 (7) construct a complex structure, product, or model to 131.1 mathematical specifications; and 131.2 (8) analyze an existing complex structure, product, or 131.3 system for purposes of maintenance, repair, troubleshooting, or 131.4 optimizing function. 131.5 ARTICLE 12 131.6 REQUIRED: SCIENTIFIC CONCEPTS AND APPLICATIONS 131.7 Section 1. [DIRECT SCIENCE EXPERIENCE - PRIMARY.] 131.8 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Engage students in active 131.9 science experiences that promote understanding of basic science 131.10 concepts and processes in order to develop a foundation for 131.11 science literacy. 131.12 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 131.13 understanding of: 131.14 (1) observable characteristics of organisms; 131.15 (2) basic needs of organisms and how they are met; 131.16 (3) responses of organisms to changes in the environment; 131.17 (4) observable properties of objects, including size, 131.18 weight, shape, and temperature; 131.19 (5) patterns that occur in nature, including objects in the 131.20 sky, weather, growth, and seasonal change; 131.21 (6) how the environment is impacted by the personal use of 131.22 materials, energy, and water; and 131.23 (7) the nature of science, including: 131.24 (i) performing experiments; 131.25 (ii) supporting ideas with personal observations; and 131.26 (iii) understanding that all kinds of people around the 131.27 world do science. 131.28 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 131.29 to: 131.30 (1) engage in teacher-guided inquiry using the primary 131.31 inquiry standard; 131.32 (2) practice safety in science, including washing hands 131.33 after participating in a science experiment, wearing goggles 131.34 when appropriate, following directions related to science 131.35 safety, not tasting substances or materials used in science 131.36 activities or experiments, and practicing safe and humane care 132.1 of animals; and 132.2 (3) use simple technology, including hand lenses, simple 132.3 balances, and other basic measurement tools to extend their 132.4 exploration and observation of objects and organisms. 132.5 Sec. 2. [LIVING AND NONLIVING SYSTEMS - INTERMEDIATE.] 132.6 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigating living and 132.7 nonliving systems in order to make sense of the world and build 132.8 a stronger foundation for science literacy. 132.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 132.10 understanding of: 132.11 (1) basic structures and functions of the human body, 132.12 including the skeletal system, the circulatory system, and the 132.13 digestive system; 132.14 (2) all living organisms survival characteristics that help 132.15 them thrive in their existing environment; 132.16 (3) cycles in: 132.17 (i) living systems, including life cycles; 132.18 (ii) earth systems, including the water cycle, seasons, and 132.19 weathering; and 132.20 (iii) environmental systems, including energy flow and 132.21 material cycles (for example, in food webs and recycling); 132.22 (4) patterns in: 132.23 (i) living systems, including the grouping of plants and 132.24 animals based on their observable characteristics; 132.25 (ii) earth systems, including features of the earth's 132.26 surface, weather, and the earth's relationship to the sun and 132.27 moon; 132.28 (iii) physical systems, including the grouping of materials 132.29 based on their properties, including floating and sinking, 132.30 solids and liquids, and change in the properties of materials 132.31 caused by heating and cooling; and 132.32 (iv) environmental systems, including populations and the 132.33 physical environment; 132.34 (5) forces that cause changes in speed or direction of 132.35 motion; 132.36 (6) the impact of human behavior and technology use on the 133.1 environment; and 133.2 (7) the nature of science, including: 133.3 (i) the role of experimentation and evidence in developing 133.4 scientific ideas; and 133.5 (ii) the role men and women with diverse perspectives play 133.6 in the development of scientific knowledge. 133.7 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 133.8 to: 133.9 (1) plan and conduct a scientific inquiry with some 133.10 assistance or scripting using the intermediate inquiry standard; 133.11 (2) create or use a model to explain how parts of a system 133.12 interact; 133.13 (3) communicate the relationship between variable and 133.14 experimental results; 133.15 (4) use simple technology to complete an inquiry, including 133.16 the use of magnifying equipment, mechanical balances, and 133.17 thermometers; and 133.18 (5) follow appropriate safety behavior as directed in the 133.19 use of goggles, heat sources, electricity, glass, and chemicals 133.20 and biological materials. 133.21 Sec. 3. [PHYSICAL SYSTEMS - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 133.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Develop understanding of the 133.23 cause and effect relationships in everyday observations of 133.24 materials, motion, and other energy forms. 133.25 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 133.26 understanding of: 133.27 (1) properties of materials that are independent of the 133.28 size of the sample, including, but not limited to, density, 133.29 solubility, and electrical conductivity; 133.30 (2) physical and chemical changes, including those 133.31 resulting from heating and simple chemical reactions; 133.32 (3) the idea that in chemical reactions the total amount of 133.33 mass does not change; 133.34 (4) forces and motion, including speed, acceleration, and 133.35 laws of motion; 133.36 (5) transfer of energy, including motion, heat, light, and 134.1 electricity; and 134.2 (6) the history and nature of science, including: 134.3 (i) the idea that scientific ideas are tentative, 134.4 reproducible, and subject to change; 134.5 (ii) that it is normal for scientists to question the 134.6 interpretation of data; 134.7 (iii) that questioning, response to criticism, and open 134.8 communication are important to the process of science; and 134.9 (iv) that the body of science knowledge has been built by 134.10 individuals from many cultures and beliefs. 134.11 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 134.12 to: 134.13 (1) independently formulate questions based on prior 134.14 observations and evidence to provide answers through scientific 134.15 investigations; 134.16 (2) design and conduct, with minimal assistance, a 134.17 scientific investigation (for example, an experiment or a field 134.18 study); 134.19 (3) choose appropriate scientific technology to gather and 134.20 analyze data and evidence; 134.21 (4) use mathematical representations or two- and 134.22 three-dimensional models to interpret and communicate data and 134.23 evidence; 134.24 (5) use their own and other students' evidence collected by 134.25 valid scientific investigations to develop descriptions, 134.26 explanations, predictions, and models; 134.27 (6) describe how evidence and established science ideas do 134.28 or do not support a claim made in public media (for example, 134.29 advertisements and reports of scientific studies); and 134.30 (7) use appropriate safety equipment and follow safety 134.31 procedures, including: 134.32 (i) using goggles when working with glass, chemicals, heat, 134.33 and projectiles; 134.34 (ii) disposing of materials properly; 134.35 (iii) following established laboratory rules; and 134.36 (iv) operating safety equipment provided in the laboratory 135.1 or field. 135.2 Sec. 4. [LIVING SYSTEMS - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 135.3 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Identify and analyze 135.4 interactions and interdependence of living systems. 135.5 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 135.6 understanding of: 135.7 (1) the relationship among groups of organisms, including: 135.8 (i) animals, including humans; 135.9 (ii) plants; and 135.10 (iii) micro-organisms; 135.11 (2) cell structure and function (for example, the cell as a 135.12 building block and the cell's role in reproduction); 135.13 (3) diversity and adaptation, including: 135.14 (i) how natural selection accounts for the diversity of 135.15 species; and 135.16 (ii) how changes in environmental conditions can affect the 135.17 survival of individual organisms and entire species; 135.18 (4) populations and ecosystems, including: 135.19 (i) that an ecosystem includes all populations living 135.20 together and their interactions with physical factors; 135.21 (ii) how populations are categorized by the function they 135.22 serve in an ecosystem; 135.23 (iii) the importance of sunlight as the major source of 135.24 energy for an ecosystem; and 135.25 (iv) that the number of organisms that an ecosystem can 135.26 support depends on adequate biotic and abiotic resources; 135.27 (5) behavior and regulation, including: 135.28 (i) how organisms maintain a stable life cycle in a 135.29 constantly changing external environment; 135.30 (ii) how regulation of an organism's internal environment 135.31 involves sensing and changing; and 135.32 (iii) how an organism's behavior evolves through adaptation 135.33 to its environment; 135.34 (6) reproduction and heredity, including: 135.35 (i) how some organisms reproduce sexually and some 135.36 asexually; and 136.1 (ii) how hereditary information is contained in the genes 136.2 and is passed from one generation to another; 136.3 (7) the dynamic effect of humans interacting with the 136.4 environment; and 136.5 (8) the history and nature of science, including: 136.6 (i) the idea that scientific ideas are tentative, 136.7 reproducible, and subject to change; 136.8 (ii) that it is normal for scientists to question the 136.9 interpretation of data; 136.10 (iii) that questioning, response to criticism, and open 136.11 communication are important to the process of science; and 136.12 (iv) that the body of science knowledge has been built by 136.13 individuals from many cultures and beliefs. 136.14 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 136.15 to: 136.16 (1) independently formulate questions based on prior 136.17 observations and evidence and to provide answers through 136.18 scientific investigations; 136.19 (2) design and conduct, with minimal assistance, a 136.20 scientific investigation (for example, an experiment or a field 136.21 study); 136.22 (3) choose appropriate scientific technology to gather and 136.23 analyze data and evidence (for example, microscopes, probes, 136.24 computers, and thermometers) to measure liquids, air, and soil; 136.25 (4) use mathematical representations or two- and 136.26 three-dimensional models to interpret and communicate data and 136.27 evidence; 136.28 (5) use their own and other students' evidence collected by 136.29 valid scientific investigations to develop descriptions, 136.30 explanations, predictions, and models; 136.31 (6) describe how evidence and established science ideas do 136.32 or do not support a claim made in public media (for example, 136.33 advertisements and reports of scientific studies); and 136.34 (7) use appropriate safety equipment and follow safety 136.35 procedures, including: 136.36 (i) using goggles when working with glass, chemicals, heat, 137.1 and projectiles; 137.2 (ii) disposing of materials properly; 137.3 (iii) following established laboratory rules; and 137.4 (iv) operating safety equipment provided in the laboratory 137.5 or field. 137.6 Sec. 5. [EARTH SYSTEMS - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 137.7 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Students will utilize concepts 137.8 and investigations to evaluate interactions of earth and space 137.9 systems and how they impact the earth and its human life. 137.10 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 137.11 understanding of: 137.12 (1) the structures and processes of earth systems, 137.13 including: 137.14 (i) plate tectonics and earth layers occurring in the 137.15 geosphere; 137.16 (ii) the water cycle, erosion, and water bodies in the 137.17 hydrosphere; and 137.18 (iii) weather and climate as a function of the atmosphere; 137.19 (2) concepts of change and constancy in the earth's 137.20 history, including evidence found in rocks, landforms, and 137.21 fossils; 137.22 (3) scientific theories of the earth's origin and 137.23 evolution, including: 137.24 (i) formation from a nebular cloud of dust; 137.25 (ii) methods of estimating geologic time; and 137.26 (iii) interactions among the solid earth, the oceans, the 137.27 atmosphere, and organisms; 137.28 (4) the relative positions and motion of objects in the 137.29 solar system, including: 137.30 (i) planetary motion; 137.31 (ii) moon phases and tides; 137.32 (iii) seasons; and 137.33 (iv) eclipses; 137.34 (5) the structure and evolution of the universe, including: 137.35 (i) galaxies; 137.36 (ii) stars; and 138.1 (iii) time and distance relationships; and 138.2 (6) the history and nature of science, including: 138.3 (i) the idea that scientific ideas are tentative and 138.4 subject to change; 138.5 (ii) that it is normal for scientists to question the 138.6 interpretation of data; 138.7 (iii) that questioning, response to criticism, and open 138.8 communication are important to the process of science; and 138.9 (iv) that the body of science knowledge has been built by 138.10 individuals from many cultures and beliefs. 138.11 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 138.12 to: 138.13 (1) independently formulate questions based on prior 138.14 observations and evidence and to provide answers through 138.15 scientific investigations; 138.16 (2) design and conduct, with minimal assistance, a 138.17 scientific investigation (for example, an experiment or a field 138.18 study); 138.19 (3) choose appropriate scientific technology to gather and 138.20 analyze data and evidence (for example, microscopes, probes, 138.21 computers, and thermometers) to measure liquids, air, and soil; 138.22 (4) use mathematical representations or two- and 138.23 three-dimensional models to interpret and communicate data and 138.24 evidence; 138.25 (5) use their own and other students' evidence collected by 138.26 valid scientific investigations to develop descriptions, 138.27 explanations, predictions, and models; 138.28 (6) describe how evidence and established science ideas do 138.29 or do not support a claim made in public media (for example, 138.30 advertisements and reports of scientific studies); and 138.31 (7) use appropriate safety equipment and follow safety 138.32 procedures, including: 138.33 (i) using goggles when working with glass, chemicals, heat, 138.34 and projectiles; 138.35 (ii) disposing of materials properly; and 138.36 (iii) following established laboratory rules and operating 139.1 safety equipment provided in the laboratory or field. 139.2 Sec. 6. [BIOLOGY - HIGH SCHOOL LEVEL.] 139.3 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate living systems at a 139.4 molecular level. 139.5 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate 139.6 understanding of: 139.7 (1) mechanisms of heredity, including: 139.8 (i) how new genes have a wide variety of effects; 139.9 (ii) how sorting and recombining genes result in a wide 139.10 variety of possibilities in offspring; 139.11 (iii) how information is passed from parent to offspring 139.12 through coding in DNA; 139.13 (iv) that gene mutations can be caused by such things as 139.14 radiation and chemicals (for example, ingested and inhaled 139.15 drugs); and 139.16 (v) how cell differentiation provides organisms with 139.17 tissues, organs, and systems; 139.18 (2) biological evolution, including: 139.19 (i) that the earth's present day range of species developed 139.20 from preexisting species; 139.21 (ii) how mechanisms for evolution are provided through 139.22 natural selection; 139.23 (iii) that natural selection gives rise to cells' and 139.24 organisms' behaviors and to cell and organisms that are able to 139.25 survive in particular environments; and 139.26 (iv) that the theory of natural selection provides a 139.27 scientific explanation for the history of life on earth; 139.28 (3) interdependence between organisms and environments, 139.29 including: 139.30 (i) how ecosystems can be reasonably stable over hundreds 139.31 or thousands of years; 139.32 (ii) that ecosystems always change when climate changes or 139.33 when one or more new species appear as a result of migration or 139.34 local evolution; and 139.35 (iii) human activities can, deliberately or inadvertently, 139.36 alter the equilibrium of an ecosystem; 140.1 (4) flow of matter and energy, including how the amount of 140.2 life any environment can support is limited by the available 140.3 energy, water, oxygen, minerals, and by the ability of 140.4 ecosystems to recycle the residue of dead organic material; 140.5 (5) behavior of cells and organisms, including: 140.6 (i) how nervous systems in multicellular animals generate 140.7 behavior; 140.8 (ii) how behavioral responses to internal changes and 140.9 external stimuli occur in organisms; and 140.10 (iii) how behavioral responses can be either innate or 140.11 learned and have evolved to ensure reproductive success; 140.12 (6) the historical significance of a major scientific or 140.13 technological advance in biological systems, including 140.14 contributions of individuals with diverse perspectives; and 140.15 (7) the nature of science, including: 140.16 (i) how historical and current scientific concepts and 140.17 knowledge guide scientific inquiries; 140.18 (ii) that scientific inquiries are performed to test ideas 140.19 and predictions and to learn about the natural world; 140.20 (iii) how the use of various technologies influences 140.21 investigations; 140.22 (iv) the essential role of mathematics in scientific 140.23 inquiry; 140.24 (v) how science knowledge based on evidence adheres to 140.25 established scientific criteria; and 140.26 (vi) the traditions that govern the conduct of scientists. 140.27 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 140.28 to: 140.29 (1) design and conduct a scientific investigation using one 140.30 of the following high school inquiry standards: 140.31 (i) research process; or 140.32 (ii) issue analysis; or 140.33 (iii) field study; or 140.34 (iv) case study; 140.35 (2) apply technology (for example, the use of sensors and 140.36 probes, microscopes, environmental sampling tools, analysis with 141.1 spreadsheets, computer simulations to solve problems, 141.2 computerized electron microscope images, and invention of 141.3 equipment or tools); and 141.4 (3) practice science safely, including: 141.5 (i) using equipment properly and following other standard 141.6 laboratory procedures; 141.7 (ii) identifying safety hazards and risk factors of 141.8 technological equipment being used; 141.9 (iii) using proper methods of disposing of chemicals and 141.10 biological materials; and 141.11 (iv) knowing emergency procedures and the location of 141.12 safety equipment. 141.13 Sec. 7. [CONCEPTS IN CHEMISTRY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 141.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Develop scientific literacy 141.15 through understanding concepts, theories, and principles in 141.16 chemistry by analysis and investigation. 141.17 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 141.18 understanding of: 141.19 (1) atomic structure, including: 141.20 (i) structure of atoms; 141.21 (ii) properties of isotopes; and 141.22 (iii) radioactive processes; 141.23 (2) structure and properties of matter, including: 141.24 (i) knowledge of elements; 141.25 (ii) measurement of basic properties of matter (for 141.26 example, thermal expansion, electrical conductivity, crystal 141.27 structure, and solubility); 141.28 (iii) patterns in the periodic table; 141.29 (iv) the role of electrons in all types of bonding; and 141.30 (v) formation and properties of inorganic and organic 141.31 substances (for example, polymers and large molecules essential 141.32 to life); 141.33 (3) chemical reactions, including: 141.34 (i) evidence of chemical reactions; 141.35 (ii) energy changes in chemical system; 141.36 (iii) determining the factors that affect the rate of a 142.1 reaction; and 142.2 (iv) common chemical reactions that occur in kitchens, 142.3 living systems, and the environment; 142.4 (4) the history of science, including the historical 142.5 significance of a major scientific or technological advance in 142.6 chemistry and the importance of multiple contributions by 142.7 individuals with diverse perspectives; and 142.8 (5) the nature of science, including: 142.9 (i) how historical and current scientific concepts and 142.10 knowledge guide scientific inquiries; 142.11 (ii) that scientific inquiries are performed to test ideas 142.12 and predictions and to learn about the natural world; 142.13 (iii) how the use of various technologies influences the 142.14 investigations; 142.15 (iv) the essential rule of mathematics in scientific 142.16 inquiry; 142.17 (v) how science knowledge based on evidence adheres to 142.18 established scientific criteria; and 142.19 (vi) that traditions govern the conduct of scientists. 142.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 142.21 to: 142.22 (1) design and conduct a scientific investigation using one 142.23 of the following high school inquiry standards: 142.24 (i) research process; or 142.25 (ii) issue analysis; or 142.26 (iii) field study; or 142.27 (iv) case study; 142.28 (2) apply technology (for example, the use of sensors and 142.29 probes) analysis with spreadsheets, development of computer 142.30 simulations to solve problems, and creation or invention of 142.31 equipment and tools; and 142.32 (3) practice science safely, including: 142.33 (i) using equipment properly and following other standard 142.34 laboratory procedures; 142.35 (ii) identifying safety hazards and risk factors of 142.36 technological equipment being used; 143.1 (iii) using proper methods of disposing of chemicals and 143.2 materials; and 143.3 (iv) knowing emergency procedures and the location and use 143.4 of safety equipment. 143.5 Sec. 8. [EARTH AND SPACE SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL LEVEL.] 143.6 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate and analyze earth 143.7 and space systems through application of concepts, theories, and 143.8 principles. 143.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 143.10 understanding of: 143.11 (1) energy in the earth system, including internal and 143.12 external sources of energy and the transfer of energy; 143.13 (2) interaction of forces and energy, including, but not 143.14 limited to, fault systems, movement of earth materials, and star 143.15 systems; 143.16 (3) geochemical processes and cycles, including movement 143.17 and sinking of elements and the physical and chemical changes 143.18 caused by this movement; 143.19 (4) theory of origins and evolution of the universe, 143.20 including "big bang," gravitational attraction of matter, and 143.21 nuclear reactions in stars to produce elements; 143.22 (5) potential environmental problems related to earth and 143.23 space systems; 143.24 (6) the history of science, including the historical 143.25 significance of a major scientific or technological advance in 143.26 earth and space systems and the importance of multiple 143.27 contributions by individuals with diverse perspectives; and 143.28 (7) the nature of science, including: 143.29 (i) how historical and current scientific concepts and 143.30 knowledge guide scientific inquiries; 143.31 (ii) that scientific inquiries are performed to test 143.32 predictions, verify ideas, and to learn about the natural world; 143.33 (iii) how the use of various technologies influences the 143.34 investigations; 143.35 (iv) the essential role of mathematics in scientific 143.36 inquiry; 144.1 (v) how science knowledge based on evidence adheres to 144.2 established scientific criteria; and 144.3 (vi) that traditions govern the conduct of scientists. 144.4 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 144.5 to: 144.6 (1) design and conduct a scientific investigation using one 144.7 of the following high school inquiry standards: 144.8 (i) research process; or 144.9 (ii) issue analysis; or 144.10 (iii) field study; or 144.11 (iv) case study; 144.12 (2) apply appropriate learning and analysis technologies 144.13 (for example, sensors and probes, graphing calculators, 144.14 spreadsheets, computer simulations, field sampling equipment, 144.15 and downlinks from real-time databases); and 144.16 (3) practice science safely, including: 144.17 (i) using equipment properly and following other standard 144.18 laboratory procedures; 144.19 (ii) identifying safety hazards and risk factors of 144.20 technological equipment being used; and 144.21 (iii) using proper methods of disposing of chemicals and 144.22 materials and knowing emergency procedures and the location and 144.23 use of safety equipment. 144.24 Sec. 9. [CONCEPTS IN PHYSICS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 144.25 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate and develop an 144.26 understanding of the makeup, structure, and function of the 144.27 physical world. 144.28 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate 144.29 understanding of: 144.30 (1) how forces can produce a variety of types of motions; 144.31 (2) how the concepts of conservation of energy, momentum, 144.32 and charge are used to analyze events and solve problems; 144.33 (3) wave motion, including sound, light, and other 144.34 electromagnetic waves; 144.35 (4) electricity, magnetism, and electromagnetism; 144.36 (5) the development of ideas in modern physics, including 145.1 atomic and nuclear physics, relativity, quantum physics, and 145.2 fundamental particles; 145.3 (6) the history of science, including the historical 145.4 significance of a major scientific or technological advance in 145.5 physics and the importance of multiple contributions by 145.6 individuals with diverse perspectives; and 145.7 (7) the nature of science, including: 145.8 (i) how historical and current scientific concepts and 145.9 knowledge guide scientific inquiries; 145.10 (ii) that scientific inquiries are performed to test 145.11 predictions, verify ideas, and to learn about the natural world; 145.12 (iii) how the use of various technologies influences the 145.13 investigations; 145.14 (iv) the essential role of mathematics in scientific 145.15 inquiry; 145.16 (v) how science knowledge based on evidence adheres to 145.17 established scientific criteria; and 145.18 (vi) that traditions govern the conduct of scientists. 145.19 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 145.20 to: 145.21 (1) design and conduct a scientific investigation using one 145.22 of the following high school inquiry standards: 145.23 (i) research process; or 145.24 (ii) issue analysis; or 145.25 (iii) field study; or 145.26 (iv) case study; 145.27 (2) apply appropriate learning and analysis technologies 145.28 (for example, sensors and probes, analysis with spreadsheets, 145.29 computer simulations, and invention of equipment, tools, or 145.30 circuits); and 145.31 (3) practice science safely, including: 145.32 (i) using equipment properly and following other standard 145.33 laboratory procedures; 145.34 (ii) identifying safety hazards and risk factors of 145.35 technological equipment being used; and 145.36 (iii) using proper methods of disposing of chemicals or 146.1 materials and knowing emergency procedures and the location and 146.2 use of safety equipment. 146.3 Sec. 10. [ENVIRONMENTAL SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL LEVEL.] 146.4 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Evaluate a local or regional 146.5 environmental issue, select a solution, and prepare a plan to 146.6 carry out the solution. 146.7 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall have an understanding 146.8 of: 146.9 (1) environmental systems representing the interaction of 146.10 natural and social systems; 146.11 (2) local, regional, or global environmental issues (for 146.12 example, personal and community health, population growth, 146.13 natural resources, environmental quality, and natural and human 146.14 induced hazards); 146.15 (3) science concepts associated with environmental issues, 146.16 including: 146.17 (i) processes that shape the earth (for example, forces 146.18 that change the surface of the earth, energy flow, and material 146.19 cycles in earth systems); and 146.20 (ii) characteristics and processes of living systems (for 146.21 example, organisms, populations and communities, heredity and 146.22 evolution, systems and connections, the flow of energy, and the 146.23 cycling of matter); 146.24 (4) types of social systems that interact with natural 146.25 systems (for example, economic, political, and technological); 146.26 (5) the historical significance of a major scientific or 146.27 technological advance in environmental systems and the 146.28 importance of multiple contributions by individuals with diverse 146.29 perspectives; and 146.30 (6) the nature of science in environmental systems, 146.31 including: 146.32 (i) how historical and current understanding of natural 146.33 systems guide environmental decision making; 146.34 (ii) that research and inquiries are performed to test 146.35 ideas, verify ideas, and make predictions about changes in 146.36 environmental systems; 147.1 (iii) how progress in science and technology are affected 147.2 by social issues and challenges; 147.3 (iv) how environmental decisions involve assessment of 147.4 alternatives, risks, costs, and benefits; and 147.5 (v) the traditions that govern the conduct of researchers. 147.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 147.7 to: 147.8 (1) identify components of an existing local or regional 147.9 environmental issue, including: 147.10 (i) scientific concepts related to or embedded in the 147.11 issue; and 147.12 (ii) social systems involved in the issue; 147.13 (2) conduct a science-based investigation of a local or 147.14 regional environmental issue using the issue analysis standard 147.15 from inquiry and research learning area; 147.16 (3) develop and give rationale for a personal action plan 147.17 designed to promote a specified solution; 147.18 (4) apply appropriate learning and analysis technologies 147.19 (for example, sensors and probes, graphing calculators, 147.20 spreadsheets, computer simulations and models, field sampling 147.21 equipment, and downlinks from real-time databases); and 147.22 (5) practice science safely, including: 147.23 (i) using equipment properly and following standard 147.24 laboratory and field procedures; 147.25 (ii) identifying safety hazards and risk factors of 147.26 technological equipment being used; 147.27 (iii) using proper methods for disposing of chemicals, 147.28 field waste, and used materials; and 147.29 (iv) knowing emergency procedures and the location and use 147.30 of safety equipment. 147.31 Sec. 11. [REQUIRED SCIENCE STANDARDS FOR GRADUATION.] 147.32 High school students must complete standards from at least 147.33 two of the science areas in sections 6 to 10 of this article. 147.34 ARTICLE 13 147.35 REQUIRED: SOCIAL SCIENCES 147.36 Section 1. [FAMILY, SCHOOL, AND COMMUNITY - PRIMARY.] 148.1 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the interaction of 148.2 the individual, family, school, community, and place. 148.3 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 148.4 understanding of: 148.5 (1) how individuals and groups responsibly meet wants and 148.6 needs when resources (for example, food, shelter, and clothing) 148.7 are scarce; 148.8 (2) how citizens responsibly make choices by considering 148.9 the needs of the individual, home, school, and community; 148.10 (3) the location of the local community and country in 148.11 relation to larger geographic area; 148.12 (4) the location of major geographic features of the 148.13 earth's surface; 148.14 (5) the physical features of communities (for example, 148.15 climate, vegetation, land forms, or bodies of water); 148.16 (6) human features of communities (for example, population 148.17 distribution, settlement patterns, or cultural diversity); 148.18 (7) the reason for location of communities or features of 148.19 communities; 148.20 (8) the ethnic and national backgrounds of various 148.21 community members; and 148.22 (9) how different individuals respond differently to the 148.23 same event. 148.24 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 148.25 to: 148.26 (1) explain how the student's home region has changed over 148.27 time; 148.28 (2) create a timeline of personal history using simple 148.29 historical research based on primary sources (for example, 148.30 photos, personal artifacts, or family interviews); 148.31 (3) create maps, including mental maps that show an 148.32 understanding of the relative location of the community in 148.33 relation to larger geographic areas; and 148.34 (4) identify, investigate, discuss, and plan, based on 148.35 wants and needs, how to improve the school, community, or 148.36 environment. 149.1 Sec. 2. [HISTORICAL EVENTS - INTERMEDIATE.] 149.2 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand that historical 149.3 events are influenced by multiple factors, including the 149.4 contributions of key people; the influence of technology; and 149.5 conflict, cooperation, and interdependence among people. 149.6 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 149.7 understanding of: 149.8 (1) the multiple causes and effects of an historical event 149.9 (for example, the causes of the American Revolution and the 149.10 results of the conflict); 149.11 (2) how technology influences historical change (for 149.12 example, the influence of railroads on the growth of the United 149.13 States, the changes in sailing ships that allowed European 149.14 exploration, or the development of irrigation systems in ancient 149.15 cultures); 149.16 (3) the contribution of individuals to historical events 149.17 (for example, the signers of the Declaration of Independence or 149.18 modern civil rights leaders); and 149.19 (4) conflict, cooperation, and interdependence among 149.20 individuals, groups, and nations through time (for example, the 149.21 relationship between American Indians and Europeans in the early 149.22 colonial period). 149.23 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 149.24 to: 149.25 (1) create a brief historical narrative from the point of 149.26 view of a community member by gathering primary and secondary 149.27 historical information through interviews, photos, or other 149.28 sources; and 149.29 (2) construct, read, and interpret timelines of key people 149.30 and events from a variety of time periods. 149.31 Sec. 3. [GEOGRAPHY AND CITIZENSHIP - INTERMEDIATE.] 149.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the role of citizens 149.33 in their own communities and the interaction of people, places, 149.34 and regions. 149.35 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 149.36 understanding of: 150.1 (1) location and physical characteristics (for example, 150.2 climate or natural resources) of the United States and selected 150.3 world regions; 150.4 (2) human characteristics (for example, cultural, economic, 150.5 political) or technological characteristics of United States and 150.6 selected world regions; 150.7 (3) interactions of people in the United States and 150.8 selected world regions; 150.9 (4) how local resources and products are moved throughout 150.10 the world; 150.11 (5) how people of different regions and cultures interact 150.12 with the environment; 150.13 (6) geographic origins of groups in the local community; 150.14 and 150.15 (7) local community needs (for example, laws, rights, and 150.16 responsibilities), resource needs, or health and safety issues. 150.17 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 150.18 to: 150.19 (1) interpret and use information from maps and graphic 150.20 representations; 150.21 (2) read a variety of different kinds of maps; 150.22 (3) create maps, including mental maps, showing the 150.23 relative location of the community to the nation and the world; 150.24 (4) compare ways people of different cultures and regions 150.25 interact with the physical environment; 150.26 (5) discuss, develop, participate in, and evaluate an 150.27 activity that contributes to the improvement of the community; 150.28 and 150.29 (6) describe ways to promote the values and principles of 150.30 American democracy. 150.31 Sec. 4. [CURRENT ISSUE ANALYSIS - MIDDLE.] 150.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Defend a position concerning a 150.33 current event or issue. 150.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 150.35 understanding of: 150.36 (1) the history, facts, controversy, values, beliefs, and 151.1 emotions surrounding a current event or issue; 151.2 (2) the range of positions and opinions surrounding a 151.3 current event or issue; and 151.4 (3) the responsibility of citizens involved in the event or 151.5 issue. 151.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 151.7 to: 151.8 (1) summarize in an oral, written, or role-play form the 151.9 central facts and opinions surrounding an issue; 151.10 (2) describe the impact of the issue on current or future 151.11 events; and 151.12 (3) select and defend a position based on information and 151.13 reasoning. 151.14 Sec. 5. [GEOGRAPHY AND CULTURE - MIDDLE.] 151.15 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand how events, the 151.16 interactions of people, the development of culture, and economic 151.17 development are influenced by physical and human geography. 151.18 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 151.19 understanding of: 151.20 (1) how regions of the world are defined in terms of 151.21 location, natural resources, people and cultures, and physical 151.22 features; 151.23 (2) the physical and cultural characteristics of selected 151.24 regions; 151.25 (3) how regions and global systems are interconnected and 151.26 interdependent; 151.27 (4) the economic development of regions (for example, the 151.28 use of resources), the development of technology, or an increase 151.29 in trade; and 151.30 (5) the impact of human and physical geography on current 151.31 or historical issues that involve particular regions. 151.32 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate an ability 151.33 to: 151.34 (1) construct and interpret maps, including mental maps, 151.35 and other graphic representations that show the location of 151.36 regions and the change of regions over time; 152.1 (2) construct and interpret maps, including mental maps, 152.2 and other graphic representations that show the interaction of 152.3 regions through the movement of people, ideas, or resources; and 152.4 (3) compare differences and similarities between world 152.5 regions in, for example, their forms of government, topography, 152.6 resource use, or ethnicity. 152.7 Sec. 6. [HISTORY AND CITIZENSHIP - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 152.8 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the role of 152.9 individuals and groups in influencing historical events. 152.10 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 152.11 understanding of: 152.12 (1) the origin and influences of diverse ideas and beliefs 152.13 in history (for example, the competing interests that lead to 152.14 the formation of the Bill of Rights); 152.15 (2) the facts, sequences, and patterns within a historical 152.16 period (for example, colonization patterns and the response of 152.17 the American Indians); 152.18 (3) themes of change (for example, significant immigration 152.19 periods in United States history and their impact on society); 152.20 (4) a continuum of change in a local community or 152.21 institution; 152.22 (5) the role of individuals and groups in influencing 152.23 change through political processes, legal processes, or other 152.24 means; and 152.25 (6) how people become citizens and how citizens contribute 152.26 to a changing community through participation. 152.27 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 152.28 to: 152.29 (1) create an historical narrative, based on primary and 152.30 secondary sources, that draws conclusions about historical 152.31 events and participants and shows an understanding of 152.32 chronology; 152.33 (2) construct and interpret thematic or multitiered 152.34 timelines to compare eras or to compare different ideas or 152.35 places within the same era; and 152.36 (3) use civic dialogue and an actual or simulated political 153.1 process to examine issues involving rights, roles, and 153.2 responsibilities. 153.3 Sec. 7. [THEMES OF UNITED STATES HISTORY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 153.4 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the development of 153.5 United States history through the study of foundational 153.6 documents, historical themes, historical eras, and diverse 153.7 perspectives. 153.8 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 153.9 understanding of: 153.10 (1) the historical influence of foundational primary 153.11 documents, including the Declaration of Independence and the 153.12 United States Constitution; 153.13 (2) cultural, political, social, scientific, or economic 153.14 themes related to key people, events, and concepts in historical 153.15 eras of the United States (for example, the convergence of 153.16 people, Civil War and Reconstruction, the Great Depression, or 153.17 contemporary United States); and 153.18 (3) how diverse ideas or beliefs have influenced different 153.19 eras of United States history, including tribal sovereignty and 153.20 the relationship between American Indian tribal governments and 153.21 federal and state government in earlier eras or in recent times. 153.22 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 153.23 to: 153.24 (1) formulate historical questions and defend historical 153.25 positions using evidence from primary and secondary sources 153.26 representing a variety of perspectives; 153.27 (2) analyze historical issues and evaluate the impact of 153.28 historical decisions; and 153.29 (3) think chronologically (for example, through developing 153.30 historical narrative or through constructing and interpreting 153.31 thematic and multitiered timelines). 153.32 Sec. 8. [UNITED STATES CITIZENSHIP - HIGH SCHOOL.] 153.33 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understands the foundations, 153.34 rights, and responsibilities of United States citizenship. 153.35 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 153.36 understanding of: 154.1 (1) the foundations, rights, and responsibilities of United 154.2 States citizenship; 154.3 (2) how the United States Constitution and other 154.4 foundational documents embody the principles and ideals of a 154.5 democratic republic; 154.6 (3) the rights and responsibilities of citizens, 154.7 noncitizens, and dual citizens; 154.8 (4) the formal and informal structures of government, 154.9 including how interest groups exercise power; and 154.10 (5) how citizens affect local, national, and foreign policy. 154.11 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 154.12 to: 154.13 (1) use research and civic dialogue to examine issues 154.14 involving rights, roles, and the status of individuals in 154.15 relation to the general welfare of society; and 154.16 (2) observe, analyze, and interact with an actual or 154.17 simulated governmental process. 154.18 Sec. 9. [DIVERSE PERSPECTIVES - HIGH SCHOOL.] 154.19 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Evaluate events and actions from 154.20 diverse United States and world perspectives. 154.21 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 154.22 understanding of: 154.23 (1) how race, culture, gender, and disability may influence 154.24 beliefs, actions, and world view; 154.25 (2) how the same data can be interpreted differently 154.26 depending upon perspectives, goals, attitudes, personal history, 154.27 culture, or other factors; 154.28 (3) issues, topics, or concepts around which disagreement 154.29 or ambiguity exist; and 154.30 (4) two or more alternative points of view for one issue, 154.31 topic, event, or concept around which disagreement or ambiguity 154.32 exists. 154.33 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 154.34 to: 154.35 (1) describe, explain, and compare points of view 154.36 concerning an issue, including the reasons for alternative 155.1 points of view; 155.2 (2) evaluate events and actions from diverse United States 155.3 and world perspectives; and 155.4 (3) analyze how interpretation is affected by omitting 155.5 viewpoints. 155.6 Sec. 10. [HUMAN GEOGRAPHY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 155.7 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand how people interact 155.8 with the environment, how people of different regions interact 155.9 with each other, and how conflict or change results from these 155.10 interactions. 155.11 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 155.12 understanding of: 155.13 (1) the location of major places, regions, and geographic 155.14 features on the surface of the earth; 155.15 (2) the physical processes that shape patterns on the 155.16 earth's surface; 155.17 (3) the physical and cultural characteristics of places and 155.18 regions; 155.19 (4) how the environment is modified by and modifies human 155.20 activity; 155.21 (5) how changing relationships between humans and the 155.22 physical environment influences the characteristics of places; 155.23 (6) how places, regions, and global systems are 155.24 interconnected through the movement of people, ideas, resources, 155.25 and other cultural characteristics; and 155.26 (7) how changes in the patterns of human interaction result 155.27 in changes in the cultural landscape. 155.28 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 155.29 to: 155.30 (1) interpret and communicate geographic information 155.31 through maps and other graphic tools and geographic information 155.32 systems; 155.33 (2) predict changes or trends in physical or cultural 155.34 landscape based on changes in spatial patterns or other 155.35 geographic information; and 155.36 (3) use a geographic perspective in the analysis of a 156.1 dispute over land use, resource utilization, or political 156.2 control of territory. 156.3 Sec. 11. [INSTITUTIONS AND TRADITIONS IN SOCIETY - HIGH 156.4 SCHOOL.] 156.5 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the interaction and 156.6 development of individuals, groups, and institutions. 156.7 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 156.8 understanding of: 156.9 (1) institutions (for example, family, religion, 156.10 educational, economic, or political institutions) and the 156.11 traditions of those institutions; 156.12 (2) societal concepts that influence the interaction among 156.13 individuals, groups, and society; 156.14 (3) how societal concepts and institutions develop and 156.15 change over time; 156.16 (4) how cultural diversity affects conflict and cohesion 156.17 within and across groups and institutions; and 156.18 (5) tensions between individuality and conformity and the 156.19 groups that influence the tensions (for example, family, peer 156.20 groups, or the media). 156.21 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 156.22 to: 156.23 (1) use observation, surveys, sampling, or other research 156.24 to analyze how roles, status, and societal class affect 156.25 interaction in groups and institutions; and 156.26 (2) analyze how institutions affect continuity and change. 156.27 Sec. 12. [COMMUNITY INTERACTION - HIGH SCHOOL.] 156.28 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the relationships 156.29 between organizations and the communities they serve through 156.30 direct service or experience. 156.31 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 156.32 understanding of: 156.33 (1) the types of organizations that serve the community and 156.34 the types of assistance they offer; 156.35 (2) how organizations assess community needs; and 156.36 (3) how individuals can work to improve the community. 157.1 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 157.2 to: 157.3 (1) conduct a needs assessment to determine the impact of 157.4 an issue, event, or service on the community; and 157.5 (2) suggest, apply, and evaluate strategies designed to 157.6 improve the community through direct service or other authentic 157.7 experience. 157.8 Sec. 13. [WORLD HISTORY AND CULTURES - HIGH SCHOOL.] 157.9 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand historical 157.10 developments that gave rise to human societies. 157.11 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 157.12 understanding of: 157.13 (1) processes that influence the formation of human 157.14 societies (for example, the development of agriculture or the 157.15 development of institutions); 157.16 (2) characteristics of emerging and spreading civilizations 157.17 (for example, increased influence through trade or conquest); 157.18 (3) processes of change within societies, including reform 157.19 and revolution; 157.20 (4) causes and effects of political, social, or cultural 157.21 exchanges and encounters (for example, the contact between 157.22 Mesoamerican civilizations and the Spanish); 157.23 (5) patterns of global transformations and the rise of an 157.24 interdependent world; and 157.25 (6) unifying themes across historical eras or across world 157.26 regions in the same era. 157.27 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 157.28 to: 157.29 (1) formulate a historical question about an event, issue, 157.30 era, region, or culture; 157.31 (2) evaluate a historical question for research 157.32 feasibility; 157.33 (3) gather information from secondary sources and original 157.34 primary or translated sources; and 157.35 (4) present research findings, including conclusions about 157.36 the historical question, bias and perspective in sources, 158.1 limitations of the investigation because of time or distance 158.2 from sources, and possible questions for further research. 158.3 ARTICLE 14 158.4 REQUIRED: ARTS AND LITERATURE 158.5 Section 1. [ARTISTIC EXPRESSION - PRIMARY.] 158.6 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use artistic processes to 158.7 create, perform, and interpret art works in at least three of 158.8 the following arts areas. 158.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 158.10 understanding of: 158.11 (1) [DANCE.] 158.12 (i) the elements of dance, including action, space, time, 158.13 and energy; and 158.14 (ii) characteristics of dance from a variety of cultures 158.15 and historical times; 158.16 (2) [MUSIC.] 158.17 (i) the elements of music, including melody, rhythm, 158.18 harmony, dynamics, tone color, texture, and form; and 158.19 (ii) characteristics of music from a variety of cultures 158.20 and historical times; 158.21 (3) [THEATER.] 158.22 (i) the elements of theater, including plot, theme, 158.23 character, language, sound, and spectacle; and 158.24 (ii) characteristics of theater from a variety of cultures 158.25 and historical times; or 158.26 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 158.27 (i) the elements of visual art, including color, line, 158.28 shape, form, texture, and space; and 158.29 (ii) characteristics of visual art from a variety of 158.30 cultures and historical times. 158.31 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 158.32 to: 158.33 (1) [DANCE.] 158.34 (i) use basic movement skills in musical or rhythmic 158.35 contexts; and 158.36 (ii) create and perform sequences of movement with a 159.1 beginning, middle, and end to communicate a story, life 159.2 experience, theme, or idea; 159.3 (2) [MUSIC.] 159.4 (i) sing a varied repertoire of songs in a group; 159.5 (ii) improvise and compose on classroom instruments to 159.6 communicate an idea; 159.7 (iii) play simple rhythms and melodies on classroom 159.8 instruments; and 159.9 (iv) read and write music using a system of notation; 159.10 (3) [THEATER.] 159.11 (i) use movement, sound, and language to create images and 159.12 express ideas; 159.13 (ii) create characterizations of animals, objects, or 159.14 shapes; and 159.15 (iii) communicate a story and character using voice, 159.16 movement, costume, and props; or 159.17 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 159.18 (i) use the tools, basic skills, and techniques of at least 159.19 three different mediums; and 159.20 (ii) create original works of art to communicate ideas. 159.21 Sec. 2. [ARTISTIC EXPRESSION - INTERMEDIATE.] 159.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use artistic processes to 159.23 create, perform, and interpret art works in at least three of 159.24 the following arts areas. 159.25 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 159.26 understanding of: 159.27 (1) [DANCE.] 159.28 (i) components of dance: 159.29 (A) elements, including action, space, time and energy; 159.30 (B) principles of choreography (for example, repetition, 159.31 pattern, or unity); and 159.32 (C) vocabulary; 159.33 (ii) cultural and historical forms or traditions of dance; 159.34 and 159.35 (iii) how dance elements are similar to and different from 159.36 the elements of other arts areas (for example, music, theater, 160.1 or visual arts); 160.2 (2) [MUSIC.] 160.3 (i) components of music: 160.4 (A) elements, including melody, rhythm, harmony, dynamics, 160.5 tone color, texture, and form; and 160.6 (B) vocabulary; 160.7 (ii) cultural and historical forms or traditions of music; 160.8 and 160.9 (iii) how musical elements are similar to and different 160.10 from the elements of other arts areas (for example, dance, 160.11 theater, or visual arts); 160.12 (3) [THEATER.] 160.13 (i) components of theater: 160.14 (A) elements, including plot, theme, character, language, 160.15 sound, and spectacle; 160.16 (B) forms (for example, tragedy, comedy, farce, or 160.17 melodrama); and 160.18 (C) vocabulary; 160.19 (ii) cultural and historical forms or traditions of 160.20 theater; and 160.21 (iii) how theater elements are similar to and different 160.22 from the elements of other arts areas (for example, dance, 160.23 music, or visual arts); or 160.24 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 160.25 (i) components of visual arts: 160.26 (A) elements, including color, line, shape, form, texture, 160.27 and space; 160.28 (B) principles (for example, repetition, contrast, or 160.29 balance); and 160.30 (C) vocabulary; 160.31 (ii) cultural and historical forms or traditions of visual 160.32 arts; and 160.33 (iii) how visual arts elements are similar to and different 160.34 from the elements of other arts areas (for example, dance, 160.35 music, or theater). 160.36 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 161.1 to: 161.2 (1) [DANCE.] 161.3 (i) perform characteristic movements and styles of dance 161.4 from more than one form or tradition; 161.5 (ii) create movement sequences with or without music; and 161.6 (iii) generate multiple responses to movement ideas; 161.7 (2) [MUSIC.] 161.8 (i) sing or play traditional instruments alone and sing 161.9 rounds and part songs or play traditional instruments in a 161.10 group; 161.11 (ii) improvise and compose rhythms, melodies, and 161.12 accompaniments using classroom instruments, voice, or both to 161.13 express a specific musical idea; 161.14 (iii) perform rhythmic, melodic, and harmonic patterns on 161.15 classroom instruments; and 161.16 (iv) read and write music using a system of musical 161.17 notation; 161.18 (3) [THEATER.] 161.19 (i) create a character based on fiction or life experience 161.20 using movement, voice, costume, and props; and 161.21 (ii) create a dramatic performance by interpreting and 161.22 adapting the plot, characters, and language from an existing 161.23 piece of literature; or 161.24 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 161.25 (i) use elements, principles, skills, and techniques of at 161.26 least three different mediums; and 161.27 (ii) create original works of art to express specific 161.28 artistic ideas. 161.29 Sec. 3. [ARTISTIC INTERPRETATION - MIDDLE.] 161.30 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use artistic processes to 161.31 analyze and interpret a variety of works in at least three of 161.32 the following arts areas. 161.33 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 161.34 understanding of: 161.35 (1) [DANCE.] 161.36 (i) how the components of dance are used to convey meaning: 162.1 (A) elements, including action, space, time, and energy; 162.2 (B) principles of choreography (for example, repetition, 162.3 pattern, or unity); 162.4 (C) vocabulary; 162.5 (D) styles (for example, tap, ballet, or modern); and 162.6 (E) choreographic structures (for example, theme and 162.7 variation); 162.8 (ii) the connection between a work in dance, its purpose, 162.9 and its cultural and historical contexts; and 162.10 (iii) how the principles and vocabulary of dance are 162.11 similar to and different from other arts areas (for example, 162.12 music, theater, or visual art); 162.13 (2) [MUSIC.] 162.14 (i) how the components of music are used to convey meaning: 162.15 (A) elements, including melody, rhythm, harmony, dynamics, 162.16 tone color, texture, and form; 162.17 (B) vocabulary; 162.18 (C) styles (for example, blues, jazz, or opera); and 162.19 (D) structures (for example, ABA); 162.20 (ii) the connection between a work of music, its purpose, 162.21 and its cultural and historical contexts; and 162.22 (iii) how the vocabulary of music is similar to and 162.23 different from other arts areas (for example, dance, theater, or 162.24 visual arts); 162.25 (3) [THEATER.] 162.26 (i) how the components of theater are used to convey 162.27 meaning: 162.28 (A) elements, including plot, theme, character, language, 162.29 sound, and spectacle; 162.30 (B) forms (for example, tragedy, comedy, farce, or 162.31 melodrama); 162.32 (C) vocabulary; 162.33 (D) styles (for example, romantic or classical); and 162.34 (E) structures (for example, chronological or nonlinear); 162.35 (ii) the connection between a work in theater, its purpose, 162.36 and its cultural and historical contexts; and 163.1 (iii) how the forms and vocabulary of theater are similar 163.2 to and different from other arts areas (for example, dance, 163.3 music, or visual arts); or 163.4 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 163.5 (i) how the components of visual arts are used to convey 163.6 meaning: 163.7 (A) elements, including color, line, shape, form, texture, 163.8 and space; 163.9 (B) principles (for example, repetition, contrast, or 163.10 balance); 163.11 (C) vocabulary; 163.12 (D) styles (for example, abstract or impressionist); and 163.13 (E) structures (for example, two dimensional or three 163.14 dimensional); 163.15 (ii) the connection between a visual art work, its purpose, 163.16 and its cultural and historical contexts; and 163.17 (iii) how the principles and vocabulary of visual art are 163.18 similar to and different from other arts areas (for example, 163.19 dance, music, or theater). 163.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 163.21 to: 163.22 (1) [DANCE.] 163.23 (i) communicate a personal reaction to performances of 163.24 original works or interpretations and performances of existing 163.25 works in dance using the components of dance; and 163.26 (ii) use criteria to evaluate performances in dance; 163.27 (2) [MUSIC.] 163.28 (i) communicate a personal reaction to performances of 163.29 original works, compositions, or interpretations and 163.30 performances of existing music using the components of music; 163.31 and 163.32 (ii) use criteria to evaluate musical performances; 163.33 (3) [THEATER.] 163.34 (i) communicate a personal reaction to performances of 163.35 original works or interpretations and performances of existing 163.36 works in theater using the components of theater; and 164.1 (ii) use criteria to evaluate performances in theater; or 164.2 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 164.3 (i) communicate a personal reaction to works in visual art 164.4 using the components of visual art; and 164.5 (ii) use criteria to evaluate works of visual art. 164.6 Sec. 4. [ARTISTIC CREATIVITY AND PERFORMANCE - MIDDLE.] 164.7 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use artistic processes to create 164.8 and perform in at least three of the following arts areas. 164.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 164.10 understanding of: 164.11 (1) [DANCE.] 164.12 (i) components of dance: 164.13 (A) elements, including action, space, time, and energy; 164.14 (B) principles of choreography (for example, repetition, 164.15 pattern, or unity); 164.16 (C) vocabulary; 164.17 (D) styles (for example, tap, ballet, or modern); and 164.18 (E) choreographic structures (for example, theme and 164.19 variation); 164.20 (ii) technical skills of dance (for example, alignment, 164.21 locomotor, or nonlocomotor movement skills); and 164.22 (iii) how audience and occasion affect artistic choices in 164.23 creating and performing dance; 164.24 (2) [MUSIC.] 164.25 (i) the components of music: 164.26 (A) elements, including melody, rhythm, harmony, dynamics, 164.27 tone color, texture, and form; 164.28 (B) vocabulary; 164.29 (C) styles (for example, blues, jazz, or opera); and 164.30 (D) structures (for example, ABA); 164.31 (ii) technical skills of music (for example, singing or 164.32 playing instruments); and 164.33 (iii) how audience and occasion affect artistic choices 164.34 when composing and performing music; 164.35 (3) [THEATER.] 164.36 (i) the components of theater: 165.1 (A) elements, including plot, theme, character, language, 165.2 sound, and spectacle; 165.3 (B) forms (for example, tragedy, comedy, farce, or 165.4 melodrama); 165.5 (C) vocabulary; 165.6 (D) styles (for example, romantic or classical); and 165.7 (E) structures (for example, chronological or nonlinear); 165.8 (ii) technical skills in the theater (for example, scenery 165.9 or prop design); and 165.10 (iii) how audience and occasion affect artistic choices in 165.11 creation and performance in theater; or 165.12 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 165.13 (i) the components of visual art: 165.14 (A) elements, including color, line, shape, form, texture, 165.15 and space; 165.16 (B) principles (for example, repetition, contrast, or 165.17 balance); 165.18 (C) vocabulary; 165.19 (D) styles (for example, abstract or impressionist); and 165.20 (E) structures (for example, two dimensional or three 165.21 dimensional); 165.22 (ii) technical skills of visual arts (for example, 165.23 selecting and using tools and techniques of the medium); and 165.24 (iii) how audience and occasion affect artistic choices in 165.25 creation of visual art. 165.26 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 165.27 to: 165.28 (1) [DANCE.] 165.29 (i) use artistic processes to create and perform in a 165.30 variety of dance contexts; 165.31 (ii) express and communicate ideas using the components of 165.32 dance; 165.33 (iii) use improvisation to generate ideas for artistic 165.34 expression in dance; 165.35 (iv) make and explain artistic choices in creating and 165.36 performing dance; and 166.1 (v) use feedback to revise both creation and performance of 166.2 dance; 166.3 (2) [MUSIC.] 166.4 (i) use artistic processes to create and perform in a 166.5 variety of musical contexts; 166.6 (ii) express and communicate ideas using the components of 166.7 music; 166.8 (iii) use improvisation and composition to generate ideas 166.9 for artistic expression in music; 166.10 (iv) make and explain artistic choices in composing and 166.11 performing music; and 166.12 (v) use feedback to revise musical creation or performance; 166.13 (3) [THEATER.] 166.14 (i) use artistic processes to create and perform in a 166.15 variety of theater contexts; 166.16 (ii) express and communicate ideas using the components of 166.17 theater; 166.18 (iii) use improvisation to generate ideas for creating and 166.19 performing in theater; 166.20 (iv) make and explain artistic choices in creation and 166.21 performance; and 166.22 (v) use feedback to revise creation or performance in 166.23 theater; or 166.24 (4) [VISUAL ARTS.] 166.25 (i) use artistic processes to create in a variety of visual 166.26 art contexts; 166.27 (ii) express and communicate ideas using the components of 166.28 visual arts; 166.29 (iii) generate ideas for artistic expression in visual 166.30 arts; 166.31 (iv) make and explain artistic choices in creating visual 166.32 art; and 166.33 (v) use feedback to revise artistic expression in visual 166.34 art. 166.35 Sec. 5. [ANALYSIS AND INTERPRETATION - HIGH SCHOOL.] 166.36 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply artistic process to 167.1 analyze, interpret, and evaluate art works. (Must be completed 167.2 in literature. This standard may be repeated in dance, media 167.3 arts, music, theater, or visual arts as an elective.) 167.4 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 167.5 understanding of: 167.6 (1) [DANCE.] 167.7 (i) how a synthesis of the components of dance is used to 167.8 define a work in dance: 167.9 (A) elements, including action, space, time, and energy; 167.10 (B) principles of choreography (for example, repetition, 167.11 pattern, or unity); 167.12 (C) vocabulary; 167.13 (D) choreographic structures (for example, theme and 167.14 variation); 167.15 (E) styles (for example, tap, ballet, or modern); and 167.16 (F) technical skills (for example, alignment, locomotor, or 167.17 nonlocomotor movement); 167.18 (ii) the similarities and differences among the styles and 167.19 choreographic structures within dance; 167.20 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects criticism of a 167.21 dance creation, interpretation, or performance; and 167.22 (iv) the connections between dance and other disciplines 167.23 outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, or 167.24 history); 167.25 (2) [LITERATURE.] 167.26 (i) how a synthesis of the components of literature is used 167.27 to define a work of literature: 167.28 (A) elements, including plot, character, setting, imagery, 167.29 theme, point of view, and conflict; 167.30 (B) principles (for example, balance or repetition); 167.31 (C) vocabulary; 167.32 (D) structural forms (for example, short story, novella, or 167.33 prose poem); 167.34 (E) styles (for example, classical, romantic, or gothic); 167.35 and 167.36 (F) technical skills (for example, organization or focus); 168.1 (ii) the similarities and differences among the structural 168.2 forms and styles within literature; 168.3 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects literary 168.4 criticism; and 168.5 (iv) the connections between literature and other 168.6 disciplines outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, 168.7 or history); 168.8 (3) [MEDIA ARTS.] 168.9 (i) how a synthesis of the components of media arts is used 168.10 to define a work in media arts: 168.11 (A) elements, including image, sound, space, time, motion, 168.12 and sequence; 168.13 (B) principles (for example, repetition, unity, or 168.14 contrast); 168.15 (C) vocabulary; 168.16 (D) structures (for example, chronological or spatial); 168.17 (E) styles (for example, documentary, narrative, or 168.18 abstract); and 168.19 (F) technical skills (for example, selection and use of the 168.20 tools of the medium); 168.21 (ii) the similarities and differences among the structures 168.22 and styles within media arts; 168.23 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects criticism of a 168.24 work in media arts; and 168.25 (iv) the connections between media arts and other 168.26 disciplines outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, 168.27 or history); 168.28 (4) [MUSIC.] 168.29 (i) how a synthesis of the components of music is used to 168.30 define a composition, interpretation, or performance in music: 168.31 (A) elements, including melody, rhythm, harmony, dynamics, 168.32 tone color, texture, and form; 168.33 (B) vocabulary; 168.34 (C) styles (for example, blues, jazz, or opera); 168.35 (D) structures (for example, ABA); and 168.36 (E) technical skills (for example, singing or playing 169.1 instruments); 169.2 (ii) the similarities and differences among the structures 169.3 and styles within music; 169.4 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects criticism of a 169.5 musical composition, interpretation, or performance; and 169.6 (iv) the connections between music and other disciplines 169.7 outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, or 169.8 history); 169.9 (5) [THEATER.] 169.10 (i) how a synthesis of the components of theater are used 169.11 to define a work in theater: 169.12 (A) elements, including plot, theme, character, language, 169.13 sound, and spectacle; 169.14 (B) forms (for example, tragedy, comedy, farce, or 169.15 melodrama); 169.16 (C) vocabulary; 169.17 (D) styles (for example, romantic or classical); 169.18 (E) structures (for example, chronological or nonlinear); 169.19 and 169.20 (F) technical skills (for example, scenery or prop design); 169.21 (ii) the similarities and differences among the structures 169.22 and styles within theater; 169.23 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects criticism of a 169.24 theater creation, interpretation, or performance; and 169.25 (iv) the connections between theater and other disciplines 169.26 outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, or 169.27 history); and 169.28 (6) [VISUAL ARTS.] 169.29 (i) how a synthesis of the components of visual arts is 169.30 used to define a work in visual art: 169.31 (A) elements, including color, line, shape, form, texture, 169.32 and space; 169.33 (B) principles (for example, repetition, contrast, or 169.34 balance); 169.35 (C) vocabulary; 169.36 (D) styles (for example, abstract or impressionist); 170.1 (E) structures (for example, two dimensional or three 170.2 dimensional); and 170.3 (F) technical skills (for example, selecting and using 170.4 tools and techniques of the medium); 170.5 (ii) the similarities and differences among the structures 170.6 and styles within visual arts; 170.7 (iii) how the selection of criteria affects criticism of a 170.8 work in visual arts; and 170.9 (iv) the connections between visual arts and other 170.10 disciplines outside the arts (for example, mathematics, science, 170.11 or history). 170.12 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 170.13 to: 170.14 (1) [DANCE.] 170.15 (i) select criteria for evaluating the performances of 170.16 original dances or the interpretations and performances of 170.17 existing dances; 170.18 (ii) analyze and interpret dance through its historical, 170.19 cultural, or social context; 170.20 (iii) support personal reactions to the performances of 170.21 original dances or the interpretations and performances of 170.22 existing dances using the components of dance; and 170.23 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of performances of 170.24 original dances or the interpretations and performances of 170.25 existing dances using selected criteria; 170.26 (2) [LITERATURE.] 170.27 (i) select criteria for evaluating literature; 170.28 (ii) analyze and interpret literature through its 170.29 historical, cultural, or social context; 170.30 (iii) support personal reactions to literature using the 170.31 components of literature; and 170.32 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of literature using 170.33 selected criteria; 170.34 (3) [MEDIA ARTS.] 170.35 (i) select criteria for evaluating works in media arts; 170.36 (ii) analyze and interpret media art through its 171.1 historical, cultural, or social context; 171.2 (iii) support personal reactions to media art works using 171.3 the components of media arts; and 171.4 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of media art works 171.5 using selected criteria; 171.6 (4) [MUSIC.] 171.7 (i) select criteria for evaluating the performances of 171.8 original compositions or the interpretations and performances of 171.9 existing compositions; 171.10 (ii) analyze and interpret music through its historical, 171.11 cultural, or social context; 171.12 (iii) support personal reactions to performances of 171.13 original compositions or the interpretations and performances of 171.14 existing compositions using the components of music; and 171.15 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of performances of 171.16 original compositions or the interpretations and performances of 171.17 existing compositions using selected criteria; 171.18 (5) [THEATER.] 171.19 (i) select criteria for evaluating performances of original 171.20 works or the interpretation and performance of existing works in 171.21 theater; 171.22 (ii) analyze and interpret theater through its historical, 171.23 cultural, or social context; 171.24 (iii) support personal reactions to original works or the 171.25 interpretation and performance of existing works in theater 171.26 using the components of theater; and 171.27 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of original works or 171.28 the interpretation and performance of existing works in theater 171.29 using selected criteria; and 171.30 (6) [VISUAL ARTS.] 171.31 (i) select criteria for evaluating visual art works; 171.32 (ii) analyze and interpret visual art through its 171.33 historical, cultural, or social context; 171.34 (iii) support personal reactions to visual art works using 171.35 the components of visual arts; and 171.36 (iv) articulate informed evaluations of visual art works 172.1 using selected criteria. 172.2 Sec. 6. [CREATION AND PERFORMANCE - HIGH SCHOOL.] 172.3 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use artistic processes to create 172.4 original or perform existing works of art. (Must be completed 172.5 in dance, media arts, music, theater, or visual arts. May be 172.6 completed in a different art form or in creative writing as an 172.7 elective.) 172.8 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 172.9 understanding of: 172.10 (1) [CREATIVE WRITING.] 172.11 (i) the integration of components of creative writing: 172.12 (A) elements, including plot, character, setting, imagery, 172.13 theme, point of view, and conflict; 172.14 (B) principles (for example, balance or repetition); 172.15 (C) vocabulary; 172.16 (D) structural forms (for example, short story, novella, or 172.17 prose poem); 172.18 (E) styles (for example, classical, romantic, or gothic); 172.19 and 172.20 (F) technical skills (for example, organization or focus); 172.21 and 172.22 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 172.23 influence the creation of the writing; 172.24 (2) [DANCE.] 172.25 (i) the integration of components of dance: 172.26 (A) elements, including action, space, time, and energy; 172.27 (B) principles of choreography (for example, repetition, 172.28 pattern, or unity); 172.29 (C) vocabulary; 172.30 (D) choreographic structures (for example, theme and 172.31 variation); 172.32 (E) styles (for example, tap, ballet, or modern); and 172.33 (F) technical skills (for example, alignment, locomotor, or 172.34 nonlocomotor movement); and 172.35 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 172.36 influence the creation, interpretation, or performance of dance 173.1 works; 173.2 (3) [MEDIA ARTS.] 173.3 (i) the integration of components of media arts: 173.4 (A) elements, including image, sound, space, time, motion, 173.5 and sequence; 173.6 (B) principles (for example, repetition, unity, or 173.7 contrast); 173.8 (C) vocabulary; 173.9 (D) structures (for example, chronological or spatial); 173.10 (E) styles (for example, documentary, narrative, or 173.11 abstract); and 173.12 (F) technical skills (for example, selection and use of the 173.13 tools of the medium); and 173.14 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 173.15 influence the creation of media arts; 173.16 (4) [MUSIC.] 173.17 (i) the integration of components of music: 173.18 (A) elements, including melody, rhythm, harmony, dynamics, 173.19 tone color, texture, and form; 173.20 (B) vocabulary; 173.21 (C) styles (for example, blues, jazz, or opera); 173.22 (D) structures (for example, ABA); and 173.23 (E) technical skills (for example, singing or playing 173.24 instruments); and 173.25 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 173.26 influence the creation, interpretation, or performance of music; 173.27 (5) [THEATER.] 173.28 (i) the integration of components of theater: 173.29 (A) elements, including plot, theme, character, language, 173.30 sound, and spectacle; 173.31 (B) forms (for example, tragedy, comedy, farce, or 173.32 melodrama); 173.33 (C) vocabulary; 173.34 (D) styles (for example, romantic or classical); 173.35 (E) structures (for example, chronological or nonlinear); 173.36 and 174.1 (F) technical skills (for example, scenery or prop design); 174.2 and 174.3 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 174.4 influence creation, interpretation, or performance in theater; 174.5 and 174.6 (6) [VISUAL ARTS.] 174.7 (i) the integration of components of visual arts: 174.8 (A) elements, including color, line, shape, form, texture, 174.9 and space; 174.10 (B) principles (for example, repetition, contrast, or 174.11 balance); 174.12 (C) vocabulary; 174.13 (D) styles (for example, abstract or impressionist); 174.14 (E) structures (for example, two dimensional or three 174.15 dimensional); and 174.16 (F) technical skills (for example, selecting and using 174.17 tools and techniques of the medium); and 174.18 (ii) the cultural, historical, or social contexts that 174.19 influence creation of visual art. 174.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 174.21 to: 174.22 (1) [CREATIVE WRITING.] 174.23 (i) use artistic processes to create a single, complex work 174.24 or multiple works in creative writing; 174.25 (ii) generate and clarify artistic intent for writing; 174.26 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 174.27 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 174.28 occasion for writing; and 174.29 (v) revise writing using multiple sources of critique and 174.30 feedback; 174.31 (2) [DANCE.] 174.32 (i) use artistic processes to create an original or perform 174.33 an existing single, complex work or multiple works in dance; 174.34 (ii) use improvisation to generate original ideas for work 174.35 in dance; 174.36 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 175.1 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 175.2 occasion for dance; and 175.3 (v) revise dance using multiple sources of critique and 175.4 feedback; 175.5 (3) [MEDIA ARTS.] 175.6 (i) use artistic processes to create a single, complex work 175.7 or multiple works in media arts; 175.8 (ii) generate and clarify artistic intent for work in media 175.9 arts; 175.10 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 175.11 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 175.12 occasion for media art work; and 175.13 (v) revise media art work using multiple sources of 175.14 critique and feedback; 175.15 (4) [MUSIC.] 175.16 (i) use artistic processes to create an original or perform 175.17 an existing single, complex work or multiple works in music; 175.18 (ii) use improvisation to generate original ideas for music 175.19 composition or performance; 175.20 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 175.21 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 175.22 occasion for music composition, interpretation, or performance; 175.23 and 175.24 (v) revise music composition, interpretation, or 175.25 performance using multiple sources of critique and feedback; 175.26 (5) [THEATER.] 175.27 (i) use artistic processes to create an original or perform 175.28 an existing single, complex work or multiple works in theater; 175.29 (ii) use improvisation to generate original ideas for 175.30 theater work; 175.31 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 175.32 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 175.33 occasion for theater work; and 175.34 (v) revise original creation or interpretation and 175.35 performance of existing work in theater using multiple sources 175.36 of critique and feedback; and 176.1 (6) [VISUAL ARTS.] 176.2 (i) use artistic processes to create a single, complex work 176.3 or multiple works in visual arts; 176.4 (ii) generate and clarify artistic intent for work in 176.5 visual art; 176.6 (iii) make decisions based on artistic intent; 176.7 (iv) make choices based on analysis of audience and 176.8 occasion for work in visual art; and 176.9 (v) revise visual art work using multiple sources of 176.10 critique and feedback. 176.11 ARTICLE 15 176.12 ECONOMICS, TECHNOLOGY, AND SYSTEMS MANAGEMENT 176.13 Section 1. [INTRODUCTION TO TECHNOLOGY - PRIMARY.] 176.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Exposure to the basic concepts 176.15 of the technological world. 176.16 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 176.17 understanding of: 176.18 (1) technological world: 176.19 (i) a definition of technology; 176.20 (ii) the application of a variety of technologies in, for 176.21 example, buildings, bicycles, or telephones; 176.22 (iii) differences between natural and human-made worlds; 176.23 (iv) how needs and wants encourage the development of 176.24 technology; 176.25 (v) how technology can supply more than one solution to a 176.26 problem; and 176.27 (vi) the interrelationship between basic technological 176.28 systems and the interdependence of primary parts within a single 176.29 system (for example, a bicycle is part of a transportation 176.30 system and is made up of several subsystems such as steering, 176.31 braking, and power); and 176.32 (2) computer applications: appropriate computer technology 176.33 to access information and produce products. 176.34 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 176.35 to: 176.36 (1) technological world: 177.1 (i) document positive and negative effects of the use of a 177.2 technology from a social and environmental perspective; 177.3 (ii) develop designs or invent solutions to address human 177.4 needs and wants; 177.5 (iii) construct a model of a solution using a design 177.6 process; 177.7 (iv) use tools, materials and equipment to explore medical 177.8 technologies, agricultural and related biotechnologies, energy 177.9 and power technologies, information and communication 177.10 technologies, transportation technologies, manufacturing 177.11 technologies, or construction technologies; and 177.12 (v) explore and demonstrate how the parts of a specific 177.13 technological system work; and 177.14 (2) computer applications: 177.15 (i) identify and use the basic parts of a computer system; 177.16 (ii) gather information from electronic sources; and 177.17 (iii) use software applications to produce products, 177.18 including text and graphics appropriate for the purpose and 177.19 audience. 177.20 Sec. 2. [TECHNOLOGY SKILLS - INTERMEDIATE.] 177.21 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Explore and apply technologies. 177.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 177.23 understanding of: 177.24 (1) technological world: 177.25 (i) core technology concepts, including systems, resources, 177.26 requirements, and processes; 177.27 (ii) the interrelationship between systems and subsystems 177.28 in technology (for example, a television as part of a 177.29 communication system); 177.30 (iii) parameters, including costs, materials, safety, and 177.31 size constraints that must be considered in design; and 177.32 (iv) the design process, including needs identification, 177.33 task definition, information-seeking strategies, use of 177.34 information, synthesis, and evaluation; and 177.35 (2) computer applications: appropriate computer technology 177.36 to access, evaluate, and organize information to complete 178.1 products. 178.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 178.3 to: 178.4 (1) technological world: 178.5 (i) investigate and explain how technology has altered 178.6 peoples' perceptions of the world; 178.7 (ii) identify connections between human wants and needs and 178.8 technological developments; 178.9 (iii) troubleshoot in order to determine why something does 178.10 not work; 178.11 (iv) follow step-by-step directions to safely assemble or 178.12 create a product; 178.13 (v) correctly select and use tools; 178.14 (vi) analyze a technical device in order to identify the 178.15 system and subsystems; 178.16 (vii) apply the design process to model, test, evaluate, 178.17 and modify a design solution; and 178.18 (viii) use multiple technologies to design a solution to a 178.19 problem in a technology cluster, including medical technologies, 178.20 agricultural and related biotechnologies, energy and power 178.21 technologies, information and communication technologies, 178.22 transportation technologies, manufacturing technologies, or 178.23 construction technologies; and 178.24 (2) computer applications: 178.25 (i) gather, evaluate, and organize information from 178.26 electronic sources; 178.27 (ii) use software applications and peripheral devices to 178.28 complete a project by selecting language, format and graphics, 178.29 appropriate for the purpose and audience; 178.30 (iii) select and appropriately use input devices/sources 178.31 (for example, keyboard, voice recognition software, or 178.32 electronic tablets to enter data); and 178.33 (iv) select and appropriately use output devices (for 178.34 example, monitors, printers, audio out and projectors) to 178.35 communicate information to an audience. 178.36 Sec. 3. [GROUP RESOURCES - MIDDLE.] 179.1 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Manage resources as a team to 179.2 produce a product or service. 179.3 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 179.4 understanding of: 179.5 (1) basic principles of teamwork, including communication 179.6 skills, conflict resolution, and problem solving; 179.7 (2) background information concerning the product or 179.8 service to be produced; 179.9 (3) basic design principles, technologies, materials, and 179.10 processing of materials; and 179.11 (4) how to manage resources as a team to produce a product 179.12 or service, including human, material, and environmental. 179.13 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 179.14 to: 179.15 (1) identify a product or service to be produced as a team; 179.16 (2) recognize and utilize each team member's skills and 179.17 strengths; 179.18 (3) create a plan for the design of the product or service 179.19 and determine the resources and technologies needed to execute, 179.20 review, and revise the plan based on available resources; 179.21 (4) produce a model of a proposed product or service; 179.22 (5) conduct a market survey of a proposed product or 179.23 service; 179.24 (6) evaluate and test a proposed product or service to 179.25 determine the viability of the product (for example, 179.26 cost-effectiveness of producing the product or service); 179.27 (7) produce the product or service using appropriate 179.28 technology; and 179.29 (8) evaluate the effectiveness of a team in managing human 179.30 and nonhuman resources. 179.31 Sec. 4. [TECHNOLOGY APPLICATIONS - MIDDLE.] 179.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Participate in the development 179.33 or creation of a technological product. 179.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate 179.35 understanding of: 179.36 (1) technological world: 180.1 (i) the usefulness of technology in everyday situations; 180.2 (ii) core concepts of technology, including systems, 180.3 resources, requirements, optimization and trade-offs, processes, 180.4 and controls; 180.5 (iii) the positive and negative impact of technology on 180.6 society and the impact society has on the development of 180.7 technology; 180.8 (iv) the positive and negative impact that technological 180.9 development has on the environment and the impact the 180.10 environment has on the development of technology; 180.11 (v) the role of design in developing useful products and 180.12 systems; and 180.13 (vi) how technology has changed the designed world, 180.14 including medical technologies, agricultural and related 180.15 biotechnologies, energy and power technologies, information and 180.16 communication technologies, transportation technologies, 180.17 manufacturing technologies, or construction technologies; and 180.18 (2) computer applications: identify the types of 180.19 application software and explain their purpose or use. 180.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 180.21 to: 180.22 (1) technological world: 180.23 (i) create or adapt a design for a useful product or 180.24 system; 180.25 (ii) prepare a design model for testing, evaluation, and 180.26 modification of a product or system; 180.27 (iii) identify the criteria, constraints, and resources 180.28 necessary to produce a product or system; 180.29 (iv) develop the procedures for producing a product or 180.30 system, including automation, tooling, safety, and quality 180.31 controls; 180.32 (v) produce a product or system using appropriate 180.33 technologies; 180.34 (vi) evaluate the impact of the designed product or system 180.35 on society and the environment; and 180.36 (vii) identify the interrelationship of the designed 181.1 product or system to other systems or subsystems; and 181.2 (2) computer applications: 181.3 (i) select application software types appropriate for 181.4 specific tasks; 181.5 (ii) select and apply the feature of software products (for 181.6 example, galleries, templates, and macros); and 181.7 (iii) use software applications, including word processing, 181.8 multimedia, spreadsheets, and databases to produce products by 181.9 selecting language, format, and graphics appropriate for the 181.10 purpose and audience. 181.11 Sec. 5. [PERSONAL AND CONSUMER LITERACY - MIDDLE.] 181.12 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand the impact of various 181.13 purchases and effectively manage personal and financial 181.14 resources. 181.15 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 181.16 understanding of: 181.17 (1) the relationship between managing personal and 181.18 financial resources and meeting goals or solving problems; 181.19 (2) personal financial and nonfinancial resources, 181.20 including time, money, energy, and skills; 181.21 (3) factors that affect consumer decisions, including 181.22 consumer rights and responsibilities, external influences, and 181.23 the impact of purchases on household and local communities; and 181.24 (4) the community and global impact of consumer decisions. 181.25 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 181.26 to: 181.27 (1) implement a decision-making process in authentic 181.28 personal and consumer situations to reach a goal or solve a 181.29 problem, process, including, but not limited to: 181.30 (i) identifying an issue; 181.31 (ii) identifying financial and nonfinancial resources 181.32 relevant to the goal or problem; 181.33 (iii) generating options or solutions; 181.34 (iv) identifying consequences of each option or solution; 181.35 (v) creating an action plan; and 181.36 (vi) evaluating the plan; 182.1 (2) examine personal and household spending habits over a 182.2 period of time; 182.3 (3) differentiate between wants and needs as they relate to 182.4 available financial and nonfinancial resources and the impact 182.5 they have on a total household budget; 182.6 (4) access information concerning consumer products; 182.7 (5) evaluate the quality of products or services; 182.8 (6) describe how purchases affect the environment and local 182.9 community, including waste disposal, recycling, and limited 182.10 resources; 182.11 (7) modify and implement the action plan; and 182.12 (8) evaluate the effectiveness of the plan. 182.13 Sec. 6. [NATURAL AND MANAGED SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 182.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate the interaction and 182.15 interdependence of natural and managed systems. 182.16 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 182.17 understanding of: 182.18 (1) natural systems, including human impact on the 182.19 ecosystems and environmental changes; 182.20 (2) human managed systems, including micro and macro 182.21 systems as they relate to bioengineering; 182.22 (3) resource utilization within a system, including land, 182.23 capital, and human resources; 182.24 (4) economic value of local system as it relates to the 182.25 surrounding systems; and 182.26 (5) environmental impact of a system as it relates to the 182.27 local ecosystems. 182.28 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 182.29 to: 182.30 (1) identify and explain the nature and scope of a natural 182.31 and managed system; 182.32 (2) develop a resource management plan involving natural 182.33 and managed systems; 182.34 (3) gather and synthesize the data necessary to properly: 182.35 (i) evaluate the environmental impact of a human managed 182.36 system; 183.1 (ii) identify the interactive and interdependent 183.2 relationship between natural and managed systems; 183.3 (iii) prepare an environmental impact statement; 183.4 (iv) analyze economic impact of a plan; and 183.5 (v) identify alternative actions and relevant historical 183.6 perspectives; 183.7 (4) evaluate the interaction and interdependence of natural 183.8 ecosystems and human managed systems detailing important system 183.9 characteristic, including biological, physical, and human 183.10 characteristics; and 183.11 (5) communicate the resource management plan involving 183.12 natural and managed systems to a jury of peers by simulating a 183.13 public hearing and defending an evaluation of the proposed 183.14 system. 183.15 Sec. 7. [PERSONAL AND FAMILY FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT AND 183.16 INVESTMENT - HIGH SCHOOL.] 183.17 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply principles of personal and 183.18 family resource management through informed decision making and 183.19 use of appropriate technology. 183.20 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 183.21 understanding of: 183.22 (1) how consumer knowledge of the product, product 183.23 standards, evaluation, and comparisons are combined to create 183.24 informed consumer buying practices; 183.25 (2) options, issues, and requirements related to meeting 183.26 individual and family housing needs; 183.27 (3) terminology used in private and public agencies, 183.28 including, but not limited to, banking, investing, insurance, 183.29 taxes, employment, and unemployment; 183.30 (4) how financial and nonfinancial resources are managed by 183.31 an individual or family unit, including budgeting, spending, 183.32 saving, insurance, and investing; 183.33 (5) how consumer decisions are affected by external 183.34 influences (for example, media, peers, and technology); and 183.35 (6) how individuals and families make informed financial 183.36 decisions and the impact of those decisions on the local, 184.1 national, and global economy and environment. 184.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 184.3 to: 184.4 (1) create a plan to make a major purchase by using 184.5 consumer knowledge, product standards, and comparisons; 184.6 (2) create and analyze a household budget and explain how 184.7 financial decisions affect the budget; 184.8 (3) prepare and explain personal federal and state income 184.9 tax forms; 184.10 (4) simulate and explain the process of acquiring housing; 184.11 (5) apply a decision-making process to compare, contrast, 184.12 and analyze options for banking, credit, insurance, and 184.13 investing; 184.14 (6) determine and apply appropriate technology (for 184.15 example, financial software, spreadsheets, Web shopping, 184.16 electronic banking, and Internet tools for investments) to 184.17 personal and family financial and investment situations; and 184.18 (7) explain and analyze the interrelated effect of the 184.19 environmental and economic outcomes that are associated with 184.20 consumer purchases. 184.21 Sec. 8. [BUSINESS MANAGEMENT - HIGH SCHOOL.] 184.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply the fundamentals of 184.23 business management through informed decision making. 184.24 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 184.25 understanding of: 184.26 (1) business management fundamentals, including planning, 184.27 organizing, leading/directing, evaluating/controlling, human 184.28 resources, and communication; 184.29 (2) management theories and procedures and their 184.30 applications in the business environment, including banking 184.31 services and forms of business organization; and 184.32 (3) financial data in order to make short-term and 184.33 long-term decisions, including interpreting the data shown on 184.34 financial statements, risk management, and short-term and 184.35 long-term financing. 184.36 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 185.1 to: 185.2 (1) apply personal management skills (for example, resource 185.3 management, stress management, professional growth and 185.4 development, communication skills, or relationship building) to 185.5 function effectively and efficiently in a business environment; 185.6 (2) evaluate a business code of ethics and identify the 185.7 source of regulations that have resulted from unethical business 185.8 practices; 185.9 (3) analyze human resource functions (for example, 185.10 recruitment and selection, employee development, employee 185.11 evaluation, compensation, promotion benefits and incentives, 185.12 separation and transition, labor relations, or work-related laws) 185.13 and their importance to an organization's successful operation; 185.14 (4) utilize information and technology tools to conduct 185.15 business effectively and efficiently (for example, select 185.16 appropriate technology tools for specific business applications, 185.17 information management, marketing, organizational or 185.18 environmental costs, and analyzing the impact of an e-business 185.19 on profitability); and 185.20 (5) use service strategies to address customer needs. 185.21 Sec. 9. [FINANCIAL SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 185.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Analyze and apply financial 185.23 systems, information, and basic accounting principles. 185.24 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 185.25 understanding of: 185.26 (1) basic accounting principles related to the accounting 185.27 cycle; 185.28 (2) the accounting process, including assets, liabilities, 185.29 and owner's equity; 185.30 (3) financial systems related to accounting, including 185.31 finance, investment, and real estate; and 185.32 (4) decision making related to financial systems. 185.33 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 185.34 to: 185.35 (1) apply generally accepted accounting principles to 185.36 determine the value of assets, liabilities, and owner's equity; 186.1 (2) prepare, interpret, and analyze financial statements 186.2 using manual and computerized systems, including ratio analysis, 186.3 comparative statements analysis, cost analysis, and trend 186.4 analysis; 186.5 (3) apply appropriate accounting principles to payroll, 186.6 income taxation, managerial systems, and various forms of 186.7 ownership; 186.8 (4) create a report based on information obtained from data 186.9 analysis, including selecting, interpreting and displaying data, 186.10 and analyzing the effectiveness of past financial actions; and 186.11 (5) recommend course of action based on conclusions of data 186.12 analysis using data to drive decision-making strategies. 186.13 Sec. 10. [TECHNICAL SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 186.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Develop expertise in the design, 186.15 diagnosis, and operation of technical systems to solve problems 186.16 and extend human capabilities. 186.17 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 186.18 understanding of: 186.19 (1) the nature of technical systems, including the 186.20 characteristics, scope, and core concepts of technology and the 186.21 role technology plays within other fields; 186.22 (2) social, cultural, environmental, economic, and 186.23 political effects on technology; 186.24 (3) the impacts of technology on society, culture, 186.25 environment, economics, and politics; 186.26 (4) design principles, invention, and innovation; and 186.27 (5) the engineering systems model, including inputs, 186.28 processes, outputs, and feedback. 186.29 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 186.30 to: 186.31 (1) select a specific technology cluster, including medical 186.32 technologies, agricultural and related biotechnologies, energy 186.33 and power technologies, information and communication 186.34 technologies, transportation technologies, manufacturing 186.35 technologies, or construction technologies and apply the 186.36 engineering design process to: 187.1 (i) propose a new or modified technological product, 187.2 service, or system; 187.3 (ii) build, test, and evaluate a prototype or model of the 187.4 technological product, service, or system; 187.5 (iii) identify the resources, requirements, optimizations 187.6 and trade-offs, processes, and controls of the chosen 187.7 technological system; 187.8 (iv) investigate and analyze the inputs, processes, 187.9 outputs, and feedback of the specific technological system; and 187.10 (v) evaluate the relationship between the technological 187.11 system and the environment and analyze other positive and 187.12 negative effects of the system; and 187.13 (2) analyze the relationship of macro and micro 187.14 technological systems. 187.15 Sec. 11. [ECONOMIC SYSTEMS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 187.16 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand how individuals, 187.17 households, businesses, and governments use scarce resources to 187.18 satisfy unlimited wants and needs. 187.19 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 187.20 understanding of: 187.21 (1) the fundamental concepts of economics, including 187.22 scarcity, opportunity cost, supply and demand, markets, economic 187.23 growth, fiscal policy, monetary policy, and trade; 187.24 (2) how individuals, households, businesses, and 187.25 governments allocate scarce resources to satisfy unlimited wants 187.26 and needs; 187.27 (3) global, national, and local economic systems and how 187.28 they interact; and 187.29 (4) the impact of government decisions on economic systems. 187.30 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 187.31 to: 187.32 (1) apply economic concepts to a public issue; 187.33 (2) analyze how changes in the economy affect individuals, 187.34 households, business, government, and the environment; and 187.35 (3) compare how decisions are made in different economic 187.36 systems regarding what will be produced, how it will be 188.1 produced, and for whom it will be produced. 188.2 ARTICLE 16 188.3 OPTIONAL: HEALTH, PHYSICAL EDUCATION, AND CAREER AWARENESS 188.4 Section 1. [PERSONAL HEALTH AND FITNESS - PRIMARY.] 188.5 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand and participate in 188.6 activities that promote personal health, personal fitness, motor 188.7 skills development, and develop an awareness of self and the 188.8 world around them. 188.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 188.10 understanding of: 188.11 (1) health: 188.12 (i) the relationship between personal behaviors and health 188.13 promotion and disease prevention; 188.14 (ii) basic health and personal hygiene practices; 188.15 (iii) the essential concepts of nutrition and diet; 188.16 (iv) safety rules and practices in home, school, or 188.17 community (for example, bus, bicycle, fire, playground, car, or 188.18 stranger safety); 188.19 (v) self-awareness and interpersonal relationships; 188.20 (vi) helpful and harmful substance; and 188.21 (vii) structures and functions of body systems; 188.22 (2) physical education and fitness; 188.23 (i) at least one activity associated with each component of 188.24 health-related physical fitness (for example, cardiovascular 188.25 fitness - jogging; muscular strength - push-ups; muscular 188.26 endurance - curl-ups; and flexibility - stretching); 188.27 (ii) changes that occur in the body during vigorous 188.28 physical activity (for example, sweating, increased heart rate, 188.29 and heavy breathing); and 188.30 (iii) safety principles in activity situations; and 188.31 (3) self-awareness; 188.32 (i) a sense of self and others; 188.33 (ii) the concept of goal setting, including defining and 188.34 identifying goals; 188.35 (iii) how a step-by-step process relates to making choices; 188.36 and 189.1 (iv) requirements needed to perform daily tasks. 189.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 189.3 to: 189.4 (1) health: 189.5 (i) apply a decision-making process to health issues and 189.6 problems; 189.7 (ii) practice and maintain good personal hygiene to enhance 189.8 health; 189.9 (iii) select foods to maintain good nutrition; 189.10 (iv) recognize emergencies and respond appropriately; 189.11 (v) identify and respond to feelings in appropriate ways; 189.12 and 189.13 (vi) use refusal skills to enhance health; 189.14 (2) physical education and fitness: 189.15 (i) work to improve health-enhancing fitness; 189.16 (ii) participate in an established fitness program; 189.17 (iii) use mature locomotor movements (for example, hopping, 189.18 skipping, galloping, sliding, running, leaping, jumping, or 189.19 walking); 189.20 (iv) use nonlocomotor skills (for example, balancing on a 189.21 variety of body parts, bending, stretching, twisting, swinging, 189.22 swaying, flexing, or extending); 189.23 (v) work cooperatively with another to complete an assigned 189.24 task; 189.25 (vi) apply rules, procedures, and safety practices with 189.26 little or no reinforcement; and 189.27 (vii) combine locomotor, nonlocomotor, and manipulative 189.28 skills in patterns/sequences; and 189.29 (3) self-awareness: 189.30 (i) explore an awareness of one's self, relate 189.31 appropriately to others, and explore roles in a changing world; 189.32 and 189.33 (ii) explore how tasks can be accomplished if broken down 189.34 into small manageable steps and accomplished one step at a time. 189.35 Sec. 2. [PERSONAL HEALTH - INTERMEDIATE.] 189.36 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use a decision-making model in 190.1 daily life to promote personal health. 190.2 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 190.3 understanding of: 190.4 (1) the signs of abusive and harassing behaviors; 190.5 (2) the effects of using drugs, alcohol, and tobacco; 190.6 (3) strategies to prevent the spread of communicable 190.7 diseases; 190.8 (4) common safety hazards and their prevention at school, 190.9 home, or in the community; 190.10 (5) proper nutrition and healthy eating; 190.11 (6) interpersonal communication skills (for example, 190.12 listening skills, refusal skills, "I" messages, and conflict 190.13 resolution); and 190.14 (7) basic body systems and growth and development of the 190.15 human body. 190.16 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 190.17 to: 190.18 (1) promote healthy behaviors (for example, nutrition, 190.19 communication skills, community safety, recreation, sleep, and 190.20 rest); 190.21 (2) prevent or reduce the risk of unhealthy situations (for 190.22 example, accidents, diseases, violence, abuse, harassment, 190.23 drugs, alcohol, and tobacco); 190.24 (3) analyze and select foods that contribute to a healthy 190.25 diet; 190.26 (4) demonstrate what to do in case of illness or injury; 190.27 (5) analyze issues of safety at school, home, or in the 190.28 community; and 190.29 (6) recognize situations in daily life which require 190.30 healthy decisions and apply a decision-making model. 190.31 Sec. 3. [PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND FITNESS - INTERMEDIATE.] 190.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand and participate in 190.33 physical activities that develop motor skills and physical 190.34 fitness. 190.35 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 190.36 understanding of: 191.1 (1) components of fitness, including cardiovascular 191.2 fitness, muscular endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; 191.3 (2) components of various physical education activities, 191.4 including: 191.5 (i) rules; 191.6 (ii) skills; 191.7 (iii) strategies; 191.8 (iv) etiquette; 191.9 (v) procedures; and 191.10 (vi) safety practices; and 191.11 (3) stages of physical activity, including warm-up, 191.12 workout, and cooldown. 191.13 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 191.14 to: 191.15 (1) plan and participate in a fitness program (for example, 191.16 fitness fever or teacher-facilitated plan); 191.17 (2) show evidence of health-enhancing physical fitness (for 191.18 example, activity-level inventory, any state or national fitness 191.19 assessment, log, or journal); 191.20 (3) combine mature forms of basic manipulative, locomotor, 191.21 and nonlocomotor skills in activity situations (for example, 191.22 dribbles and passes a basketball to a moving receiver); and 191.23 (4) apply rules, procedures, and etiquette that are safe 191.24 and effective for specific activity situations. 191.25 Sec. 4. [CAREER AWARENESS - INTERMEDIATE.] 191.26 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Create an awareness of a variety 191.27 of career opportunities. Explore goal setting and a 191.28 decision-making process as they relate to future choices. 191.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 191.30 understanding of: 191.31 (1) career fields and occupations within these fields, 191.32 including agriculture and natural resources; arts, humanities, 191.33 and communications; business, management, and administration; 191.34 engineering, manufacturing, and technologies; health services; 191.35 and human services; 191.36 (2) how to define and set short- and long-term goals; 192.1 (3) the connection between a person's choices and 192.2 consequences and how they affect the world around them; and 192.3 (4) the steps of a decision-making process and the 192.4 importance of setting and achieving goals. 192.5 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 192.6 to: 192.7 (1) identify areas of personal interests, aptitudes, and 192.8 abilities; 192.9 (2) explore how academic achievement and involvement in 192.10 extra-curricular, leisure, family, and community activities 192.11 reflect personal interests, aptitudes and abilities, and affect 192.12 future possibilities; 192.13 (3) practice social skills and appropriate self-management 192.14 techniques; 192.15 (4) explore a variety of traditional and nontraditional 192.16 careers utilizing community resources; and 192.17 (5) apply a decision-making process as it relates to goal 192.18 setting for future possibilities. 192.19 Sec. 5. [PERSONAL HEALTH AND NUTRITION - MIDDLE.] 192.20 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Make informed decisions based on 192.21 valid information to promote personal health and nutrition. 192.22 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 192.23 understanding of: 192.24 (1) the impact of nutrition, including food selection, 192.25 safety, eating and eating patterns, on health; 192.26 (2) the consequences of using tobacco, alcohol, and drugs; 192.27 (3) strategies for preventing accidents; 192.28 (4) what to do in case of sudden illness or injury; 192.29 (5) the health-related impact of environmental hazards; 192.30 (6) signs and symptoms of health problems that affect 192.31 adolescents physically, socially, and mentally; 192.32 (7) sexual responsibility and the characteristics of 192.33 healthy relationships; 192.34 (8) strategies for preventing: 192.35 (i) communicable diseases; 192.36 (ii) HIV and sexually transmitted infections; and 193.1 (iii) unintended pregnancy; 193.2 (9) how health is influenced by the interaction of body 193.3 systems; 193.4 (10) where valid health information can be located at home, 193.5 school, or in the community; and 193.6 (11) the interrelationship of physical, mental, and social 193.7 health during adolescence. 193.8 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 193.9 to: 193.10 (1) recognize and respond to abusive or harassing 193.11 behaviors; 193.12 (2) apply a decision-making process relative to health 193.13 issues: 193.14 (i) in light of personal goals; 193.15 (ii) analyze internal and external influences on 193.16 health-related decisions (for example, interests, 193.17 likes/dislikes, self-esteem, risks, curiosity, 193.18 communication/media, parents, peers, ethnicity, technology, 193.19 society, and geography); 193.20 (iii) consider valid health information and resources; and 193.21 (iv) consider the impact on health promotion and disease 193.22 prevention; 193.23 (3) express needs and communicate effectively to enhance 193.24 health, including refusal skills, negotiation skills, and 193.25 conflict resolution skills; 193.26 (4) use strategies to manage stress; 193.27 (5) create and implement a nutritional health plan that 193.28 includes: 193.29 (i) dietary recommendations with respect to personal needs, 193.30 including age, gender, and activity level for a specific person; 193.31 and 193.32 (ii) menus for a specified period of time; and 193.33 (6) demonstrate and analyze food preparation and safety 193.34 skills. 193.35 Sec. 6. [PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND FITNESS - MIDDLE.] 193.36 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand fitness planning, 194.1 apply a decision-making process to achieve physical fitness, and 194.2 participate in physical activities to develop motor skills. 194.3 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 194.4 understanding of: 194.5 (1) the benefits of daily participation in physical 194.6 activities (for example, physical, mental, emotional, and social 194.7 benefits); 194.8 (2) the components of fitness planning: 194.9 (i) assessment, including cardiovascular fitness, muscular 194.10 endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; 194.11 (ii) goal setting; 194.12 (iii) implementation of FITT strategies, including 194.13 frequency, intensity, time, and type of activities; 194.14 (iv) reassessment, including cardiovascular fitness, 194.15 muscular endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; 194.16 (v) analysis of progress; and 194.17 (vi) evaluation of the proposed plan; 194.18 (3) critical elements of movement skills (for example, 194.19 overhand throw, backswing, force phase, follow through); 194.20 (4) rules, skills, strategies, and etiquette required for 194.21 three or more of the following: 194.22 (i) individual activities; 194.23 (ii) dual activities; 194.24 (iii) team activities; 194.25 (iv) dance/rhythmic activities; or 194.26 (v) outdoor activities; and 194.27 (5) the benefits and role of rules, procedures, safe 194.28 practice, ethical behavior, and positive social interaction in 194.29 physical activity settings. 194.30 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 194.31 to: 194.32 (1) design and implement a fitness plan (for example, 194.33 logging, journaling, making diary notes, charts, spreadsheets, 194.34 or graphs); 194.35 (2) participate in health-enhancing physical fitness 194.36 activities, including those that develop and maintain: 195.1 (i) cardiovascular fitness; 195.2 (ii) muscular endurance; 195.3 (iii) muscular strength; and 195.4 (iv) flexibility; 195.5 (3) analyze the effectiveness of the plan by comparing the 195.6 preplan and postplan fitness levels; 195.7 (4) perform competently in a variety of movements, 195.8 including three of the following: 195.9 (i) individual activities; 195.10 (ii) dual activities; 195.11 (iii) team activities; 195.12 (iv) dance/rhythmic activities; or 195.13 (v) outdoor activities; and 195.14 (5) reflect on the benefits and role of rules, procedures, 195.15 safe practice, ethical behavior, and positive social interaction 195.16 in physical activity settings. 195.17 Sec. 7. [CAREER EXPLORATION - MIDDLE.] 195.18 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Explore career options to make 195.19 informed decisions concerning future possibilities. 195.20 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 195.21 understanding of: 195.22 (1) a variety of occupations within career fields and 195.23 employment trends and career data for those occupations; 195.24 (2) how interests, attributes, aptitudes, and academic 195.25 achievement relate to different occupations and careers and how 195.26 they relate to personal career choices; 195.27 (3) job readiness skills and their importance in the work 195.28 place; and 195.29 (4) career and education options to make informed decisions 195.30 for future life choices. 195.31 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 195.32 to: 195.33 (1) determine personal interests, aptitudes, and abilities; 195.34 (2) research, compare and contrast, and evaluate 195.35 information on a variety of traditional and nontraditional 195.36 careers and how they relate to their interests, aptitudes, and 196.1 abilities; 196.2 (3) investigate a career through authentic situations (for 196.3 example, job shadowing, interviewing, volunteering, or community 196.4 service); 196.5 (4) apply a decision-making process to career choices based 196.6 on the relationship among educational options, employment 196.7 trends, and academic achievement; 196.8 (5) create a portfolio, including an educational plan, 196.9 interest inventories, letters of recommendation, and documented 196.10 experiences; and 196.11 (6) describe how career choices affect personal, family, 196.12 and community life. 196.13 Sec. 8. [INDIVIDUAL AND COMMUNITY HEALTH - HIGH SCHOOL.] 196.14 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Make informed decisions based on 196.15 accurate information in order to promote individual and 196.16 community health. 196.17 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 196.18 understanding of: 196.19 (1) Individual behaviors and community health practices 196.20 that: 196.21 (i) promote healthful nutrition and dietary practices; 196.22 (ii) promote physical fitness; 196.23 (iii) promote mental and emotional health; 196.24 (iv) prevent tobacco use; 196.25 (v) prevent drug and alcohol use; 196.26 (vi) prevent intentional and unintentional injuries; 196.27 (vii) prevent HIV and sexually transmitted diseases; and 196.28 (viii) prevent unintentional pregnancies; 196.29 (2) how to advocate for personal, family, and community 196.30 health; 196.31 (3) how to identify health products, services, and 196.32 information that reduce risks and promote health; and 196.33 (4) how decisions and health practices in the following 196.34 areas impact one another: nutrition, physical fitness, mental 196.35 and emotional health, tobacco, drug, and alcohol use, 196.36 intentional and unintentional injuries, HIV and sexually 197.1 transmitted diseases, and unintentional pregnancies. 197.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 197.3 to: 197.4 (1) assess and identify individual or community health 197.5 needs; 197.6 (2) evaluate an individual or community health assessment 197.7 to develop goals and strategies for health enhancement and risk 197.8 reduction; 197.9 (3) implement goals and strategies to improve or maintain 197.10 individual or community health; 197.11 (4) evaluate the impact of the goals and strategies on 197.12 health promotion and disease prevention/risk reduction; 197.13 (5) evaluate the validity of health information, products, 197.14 and services, which prevent disease and promote health; 197.15 (6) analyze how health maintenance and disease prevention 197.16 decisions are influenced by media, technological advancements, 197.17 interpersonal communication skills, immediate and long-term risk 197.18 factors, and culture; 197.19 (7) evaluate the impact of decisions on individual, family, 197.20 and community health; 197.21 (8) apply effective communication/refusal skills as they 197.22 relate to responsible decision making; and 197.23 (9) design and conduct an in-depth study of an individual 197.24 or community health need using one of the following high school 197.25 inquiry standards: 197.26 (i) research process; or 197.27 (ii) issue analysis; or 197.28 (iii) case study. 197.29 Sec. 9. [PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND FITNESS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 197.30 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand training and movement 197.31 principles, apply decision-making processes to develop and 197.32 implement a plan to achieve fitness, and participate in fitness 197.33 activities. 197.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 197.35 understanding of: 197.36 (1) the principles of training necessary to achieve 198.1 fitness; 198.2 (2) the critical elements and the biomechanical concepts 198.3 and principles of movement skills; and 198.4 (3) the procedures, including safe practices, rules, 198.5 etiquette, and strategies associated with physical activities. 198.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 198.7 to: 198.8 (1) use a decision-making process to select appropriate 198.9 physical activities to achieve fitness by designing, 198.10 implementing, and evaluating a health-enhancing fitness plan, 198.11 which includes: 198.12 (i) establishing current levels of cardiovascular fitness, 198.13 muscular endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; 198.14 (ii) setting personal goals for: 198.15 (A) physical fitness, including cardiovascular fitness, 198.16 muscular endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; and 198.17 (B) health enhancement (for example, stress management, 198.18 nutrition, and enjoyment); 198.19 (iii) selecting training strategies using the following 198.20 principles: 198.21 (A) FITT principle, including frequency, intensity, time, 198.22 and types of activities; 198.23 (B) principle of overload; 198.24 (C) principle of progression; and 198.25 (D) principle of specificity; 198.26 (iv) implementing and monitoring the plan, including 198.27 logging activities and making adjustments to the plan; 198.28 (v) reassessing levels of cardiovascular fitness, muscular 198.29 endurance, muscular strength, and flexibility; and 198.30 (vi) analyzing and evaluating the effectiveness of the plan 198.31 in helping to achieve fitness; and 198.32 (2) proficiently perform skills in: 198.33 (i) an aerobic activity; 198.34 (ii) at least two other physical fitness 198.35 activities/movement forms; and 198.36 (iii) analyze a movement skill for improved performance 199.1 using critical skill elements and biomechanical concepts and 199.2 principles. 199.3 Sec. 10. [CAREER INVESTIGATION - HIGH SCHOOL.] 199.4 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Investigate career choices 199.5 through informed decision making. 199.6 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 199.7 understanding of: 199.8 (1) how employment trends, industry standards, career data, 199.9 academic achievement, and technology affect career choices in 199.10 relationship to life goals and personal attributes; 199.11 (2) how appropriate work-based behaviors contribute to job 199.12 success; and 199.13 (3) how systems thinking can be used to evaluate and 199.14 analyze how the workplace affects and interacts with the 199.15 community and how they, in turn, affect an individual worker. 199.16 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 199.17 to: 199.18 (1) investigate a specific traditional or nontraditional 199.19 career choice by analyzing personal interests, abilities, and 199.20 strengths; 199.21 (2) investigate a career through research and an authentic 199.22 experience using multiple resources (for example, internships, 199.23 mentorship, apprenticeship, job shadowing, interviews, 199.24 volunteering, or community placement); 199.25 (3) explore and research a postsecondary program that meets 199.26 a career preparation goal (for example, postsecondary 199.27 educational institution visits, military options, on-line 199.28 searches, career fairs, or college fairs); 199.29 (4) analyze how a specific career choice affects personal, 199.30 family, and community life; 199.31 (5) analyze the implication of the changing workplace on a 199.32 specific career choice, including future skill development, 199.33 personal growth, and developments in technology; 199.34 (6) establish a career action plan incorporating a 199.35 decision-making process as it relates to career and life goals; 199.36 and 200.1 (7) establish and evaluate the contents of a portfolio of 200.2 job-seeking and placement documents, including a resume, cover 200.3 letter, letters of recommendation, follow-up letter, and career 200.4 action plan. 200.5 Sec. 11. [OCCUPATIONAL EXPERIENCE - HIGH SCHOOL.] 200.6 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Experience authentic work 200.7 situations and apply informed decision making to solve problems 200.8 at the work site. 200.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 200.10 understanding of: 200.11 (1) current and future employment trends in a selected 200.12 career field, including projected growth rate, percentage of 200.13 traditional versus nontraditional employees, and use of new 200.14 technologies; 200.15 (2) technical information, skills, and work-based behaviors 200.16 required for a specific employment opportunity, including 200.17 academic skills, communication skills, interpersonal skills, 200.18 personal qualities, and thinking skills; 200.19 (3) all aspects of an industry, including planning, 200.20 management, finances, technical and productions skills, 200.21 principles of technology, labor and community issues, health and 200.22 safety issues, environmental issues, and personal work habits; 200.23 and 200.24 (4) current work-related laws and how they affect the 200.25 employee, employer, and work environment. 200.26 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 200.27 to: 200.28 (1) evaluate and analyze personal strengths, experiences, 200.29 interests, and learning styles and how they relate to career 200.30 choices; 200.31 (2) create a portfolio of job-seeking and placement 200.32 documents, including the application, cover letter, resume, 200.33 letters of recommendation, interviewing, and follow-up letter; 200.34 (3) apply job-seeking skills through an authentic hiring 200.35 process experience; 200.36 (4) revise, implement, and maintain an educational plan to 201.1 support career goals; 201.2 (5) apply a decision-making process to handle challenging 201.3 situations as they occur at the workplace; 201.4 (6) analyze and evaluate conflicts and apply 201.5 problem-solving strategies in work relationships, including 201.6 employer-employee, coworker, and customer-client situations; 201.7 (7) identify and evaluate how technology, employee 201.8 knowledge, and skills contribute to production of a product, 201.9 service, or process on the job; and 201.10 (8) evaluate performance and work-based behaviors according 201.11 to standards and expectations of the employer and personal job 201.12 goals. 201.13 ARTICLE 17 201.14 INQUIRY AND RESEARCH 201.15 Section 1. [OBSERVATION AND INVESTIGATION - PRIMARY.] 201.16 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Gather, record, and display 201.17 information to answer a question. 201.18 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 201.19 understanding of: 201.20 (1) categorizing and classifying of information; and 201.21 (2) methods for recording and displaying information. 201.22 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 201.23 to: 201.24 (1) gather information from media sources, direct 201.25 observation, interviews and experiments, or investigation to 201.26 answer a question; 201.27 (2) record the gathered information; 201.28 (3) categorize and classify information; 201.29 (4) display the gathered information; and 201.30 (5) explain the answer to the question. 201.31 Sec. 2. [OBSERVATION AND INVESTIGATION - INTERMEDIATE.] 201.32 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Gather, record, and display 201.33 information to answer a question. 201.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 201.35 understanding of: 201.36 (1) the effect of changing one variable in an investigation 202.1 or experiment; 202.2 (2) framing a question; and 202.3 (3) the difference between primary and secondary sources. 202.4 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 202.5 to: 202.6 (1) select a topic and frame a question, gather information 202.7 from media sources, observation, and interviews; 202.8 (2) select information from print and electronic media; 202.9 (3) conduct an observation and write a detailed 202.10 description; 202.11 (4) conduct an interview with follow-up questions or design 202.12 and conduct a survey; 202.13 (5) record and organize information and report findings; 202.14 and 202.15 (6) evaluate findings to identify areas for further 202.16 investigation. 202.17 Sec. 3. [DIRECT OBSERVATION - MIDDLE.] 202.18 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Gather, record, and display 202.19 information to answer a scientific or social science question 202.20 through direct observation. 202.21 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 202.22 understanding of methods of primary research techniques, 202.23 including: 202.24 (1) observations; 202.25 (2) interviews; 202.26 (3) surveys; and 202.27 (4) questionnaires. 202.28 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 202.29 to: 202.30 (1) select a topic and frame a question; 202.31 (2) collect, record, and organize data gathered through 202.32 primary research techniques; 202.33 (3) use direct observation to: 202.34 (i) collect, organize, and record data; and 202.35 (ii) look for patterns in observable data; and 202.36 (4) display data in written, oral, visual, or electronic 203.1 format to: 203.2 (i) compare findings to other findings on the topic; 203.3 (ii) relate findings to other situations; 203.4 (iii) answer a question or present a position using data; 203.5 (iv) identify areas for further study; and 203.6 (v) evaluate the question based on findings. 203.7 Sec. 4. [SOCIAL SCIENCE PROCESSES - HIGH SCHOOL.] 203.8 A student shall access sources of social science 203.9 information and data to: 203.10 (1) formulate a question about an historical event, issue, 203.11 or interpretation of a concept; 203.12 (2) create a plan for collecting and interpreting data; 203.13 (3) evaluate a research problem for feasibility; 203.14 (4) gather information through the primary research 203.15 techniques of observations, interviews, surveys, or experiments; 203.16 and 203.17 (5) discuss research findings, including describing issues; 203.18 describing the findings from a survey of literature; presenting 203.19 primary data; identifying bias and context of data or findings; 203.20 examining how the time period and location of data source affect 203.21 the data; examining limitations of the investigation, research 203.22 process, or findings; and formulating possibilities for further 203.23 research. 203.24 Sec. 5. [RESEARCH PROCESS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 203.25 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Ask a question and investigate a 203.26 variety of resources to answer or provide information for a 203.27 discussion of the question. 203.28 Subd. 2. [PART A.] Students will demonstrate an 203.29 understanding of: 203.30 (1) primary research techniques, including quantitative and 203.31 qualitative observations, structured and unstructured 203.32 interviews, surveys, and questionnaires; 203.33 (2) secondary sources (for example, reference books, the 203.34 Internet, textbooks, and biographies); and 203.35 (3) appropriate methods of data collection. 203.36 Subd. 3. [PART B.] Students shall demonstrate the ability 204.1 to: 204.2 (1) generate a clearly defined researchable question with 204.3 subquestions; 204.4 (2) evaluate the research question for feasibility; 204.5 (3) create a plan for collecting and interpreting data; 204.6 (4) gather background information based on a survey of 204.7 related literature from a variety of sources, including: 204.8 (i) identifying key issues; and 204.9 (ii) identifying relevant historical and contextual 204.10 information; 204.11 (5) collect, interpret, and evaluate primary data, 204.12 including: 204.13 (i) quantitative and qualitative observations; 204.14 (ii) structured and unstructured interviews; 204.15 (iii) surveys; and 204.16 (iv) questionnaires; and 204.17 (6) communicate research findings through appropriate 204.18 formats (for example, abstract writing, poster display, or 204.19 informational video), including: 204.20 (i) stating the research question; 204.21 (ii) sharing findings from the survey of literature; 204.22 (iii) presenting primary data; 204.23 (iv) interpreting and analyzing information; 204.24 (v) identifying limitations of the investigation, bias, and 204.25 context of data and findings; and 204.26 (vi) describing possibilities for further research. 204.27 Sec. 6. [ACCESSING INFORMATION - MIDDLE LEVEL.] 204.28 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Access information to answer a 204.29 question or support a position. 204.30 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 204.31 understanding of: 204.32 (1) methods of recording and organizing information; and 204.33 (2) synthesizing information from primary and secondary 204.34 sources. 204.35 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 204.36 to: 205.1 (1) generate a question to be investigated or a position to 205.2 be supported; 205.3 (2) access and use a variety of sources, including 205.4 electronic media, to answer a question or support a position; 205.5 (3) determine how to record and organize information; 205.6 (4) evaluate the relevance of information found in sources; 205.7 and 205.8 (5) synthesize information to answer a question or support 205.9 a position. 205.10 Sec. 7. [MATHEMATICS RESEARCH - HIGH SCHOOL.] 205.11 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Gather and analyze information 205.12 on mathematics topic. 205.13 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 205.14 understanding of the basic process of making generalizations. 205.15 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 205.16 to design and conduct an investigation of a mathematics topic, 205.17 including: 205.18 (1) selecting and refining a topic through research; 205.19 (2) making generalizations about the topic; 205.20 (3) documenting insights gained during the investigation; 205.21 (4) connecting new concepts to familiar mathematical ideas; 205.22 (5) using mathematical properties to support a conclusion; 205.23 and 205.24 (6) communicating findings for an audience outside of 205.25 mathematics. 205.26 Sec. 8. [ISSUE ANALYSIS - HIGH SCHOOL.] 205.27 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Analyze multiple perspectives on 205.28 an issue and synthesize the findings. 205.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 205.30 understanding of: 205.31 (1) multiple perspectives of an issue; and 205.32 (2) possible bias in information gathering. 205.33 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 205.34 to research an issue and evaluate the positions and possible 205.35 solutions to the issue, including: 205.36 (1) gathering information on an issue; 206.1 (2) examining information and the process used in 206.2 collecting information for bias; 206.3 (3) identifying points of view, areas of conflict, and 206.4 points of possible compromise or agreement among groups on the 206.5 issue; 206.6 (4) evaluating the positions held, the proposed solutions, 206.7 and project consequences; 206.8 (5) identifying motives of groups; and 206.9 (6) determining feasibility of resolution. 206.10 Sec. 9. [RECORDERS OF HISTORY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 206.11 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Understand that history is 206.12 written from the perspective of the historian. 206.13 Subd. 2. [PART A.] The student shall demonstrate an 206.14 understanding of: 206.15 (1) perspective and bias as they relate to recording 206.16 historical events; and 206.17 (2) how historical accounts may differ based on the 206.18 availability and use of sources, societal influences on the 206.19 writer, and the purpose of the account. 206.20 Subd. 3. [PART B.] The student shall demonstrate the 206.21 ability to: 206.22 (1) analyze two accounts of the same historical event 206.23 written in different times and explain differences in terms of: 206.24 (i) availability and use of sources; and 206.25 (ii) societal influences on the writer and the purpose of 206.26 the account; and 206.27 (2) determine the validity of the primary sources used in 206.28 the writing of an event in history, including factors that 206.29 influence the recorder of the event. 206.30 Sec. 10. [CASE STUDY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 206.31 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Use observation and theory to 206.32 study natural systems, human interaction, learning, or 206.33 development. 206.34 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 206.35 understanding of: 206.36 (1) theories of human behavior, learning, or development; 207.1 (2) methods and techniques of primary research, including 207.2 interviews, observations, surveys, and questionnaires; and 207.3 (3) legal and ethical issues related to research, including 207.4 copyright laws, access to property, and the use of human or 207.5 other subjects. 207.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 207.7 to; 207.8 (1) refine a topic into a clear statement of a research 207.9 problem with subproblems; 207.10 (2) create a plan for collecting data, including: 207.11 (i) evaluating feasibility; and 207.12 (ii) establishing a process for conducting observations and 207.13 recording descriptions; 207.14 (3) gather and analyze data; and 207.15 (4) communicate findings, including: 207.16 (i) describing key scenes, people, dialogue, or places from 207.17 observations; 207.18 (ii) comparing finding to theories of human interaction, 207.19 learning, or development; and 207.20 (iii) identifying implications for further study. 207.21 Sec. 11. [RESEARCH AND CREATE A BUSINESS PLAN - HIGH 207.22 SCHOOL.] 207.23 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] A student shall develop and 207.24 implement a plan to start a business or organization. 207.25 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 207.26 understanding of: 207.27 (1) the scientific, economic, marketing, and sales 207.28 principles relevant to the type of business chosen; 207.29 (2) the function of a business or organization functions 207.30 within the larger economic system; and 207.31 (3) the potential impact of a business or organization on 207.32 people and communities. 207.33 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 207.34 to: 207.35 (1) gather and record information, including: 207.36 (i) researching and tracking markets; 208.1 (ii) using appropriate technology, including, but not 208.2 limited to, computers, and telecommunications satellite 208.3 technology; and 208.4 (iii) recording the data; 208.5 (2) develop a business plan, including: 208.6 (i) conducting a feasibility study; 208.7 (ii) producing a cost/benefit assessment, including human 208.8 resources; and 208.9 (iii) identifying alternative solutions to problems; and 208.10 (3) implement an actual or simulated business plan, 208.11 including: 208.12 (i) communicating information regarding decisions; 208.13 (ii) applying human relations skills; 208.14 (iii) applying relevant/useful mechanical and technical 208.15 skills; 208.16 (iv) using marketing and sales techniques; 208.17 (v) integrating economic, marketing, sales, and technical 208.18 aspects with sound environmental practices; and 208.19 (vi) analyzing the effectiveness of the plan. 208.20 Sec. 12. [HISTORY THROUGH ARTS AND CULTURE - HIGH SCHOOL.] 208.21 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Apply an inquiry process to an 208.22 art form, theme, or idea to understand historical framework and 208.23 cultural context. 208.24 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 208.25 understanding of: 208.26 (1) the influence of cultural contexts within an art form, 208.27 theme, or idea; and 208.28 (2) the concept of historical periods, including, but not 208.29 limited to, major events, conflicts, and leaders. 208.30 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 208.31 to: 208.32 (1) gather information to analyze the development of a 208.33 selected art form, idea, or theme; 208.34 (2) select, describe, and interpret works of art that 208.35 represent historical periods and development of the art form, 208.36 theme, or idea; and 209.1 (3) analyze and interpret the development in the selected 209.2 art form, theme, or idea in terms of cultural contexts for each 209.3 historical period, including, but not limited to, architecture, 209.4 technology, dominant philosophies, daily life, and social 209.5 customs. 209.6 Sec. 13. [PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT - HIGH SCHOOL.] 209.7 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Research, develop, and/or test a 209.8 product. 209.9 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 209.10 understanding of: 209.11 (1) purpose and methods of market research; 209.12 (2) characteristics of specific materials and technologies; 209.13 (3) impact of the use of specific materials and 209.14 technologies; and 209.15 (4) materials processing and/or design techniques. 209.16 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 209.17 to create or test a product, including: 209.18 (1) determining the need and the market using at least two 209.19 of the following methods: direct mail survey, telemarketing 209.20 survey, personal interview, discussion group, panels, sampling, 209.21 observations, or market analysis; 209.22 (2) correlating, tabulating, and reporting findings of the 209.23 research; 209.24 (3) designing a new or improved product, which meets the 209.25 need; 209.26 (4) analyzing the viability of product price, place, and 209.27 promotion based on research findings; 209.28 (5) creating the new or improved product; 209.29 (6) testing and evaluating the product; and 209.30 (7) assessing the impact of production, use, and eventual 209.31 disposal of the product on the environment, society, and health, 209.32 as applicable. 209.33 Sec. 14. [FIELD STUDY - HIGH SCHOOL.] 209.34 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Conduct a field study to answer 209.35 a research question. 209.36 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 210.1 understanding of: 210.2 (1) tools and methods used in a field study; 210.3 (2) impacts of technologies on traditional field studies; 210.4 and 210.5 (3) impacts of uncontrolled variables on systems. 210.6 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 210.7 to: 210.8 (1) independently formulate a question and design a study; 210.9 (2) collect, analyze, and present quantitative and 210.10 qualitative data using appropriate technology (for example, 210.11 video, still cameras, tape recorders, tree borers, trip lines, 210.12 or global positioning systems); 210.13 (3) conduct research with key experts or sample documents; 210.14 (4) take random and/or nonrandom samples under field 210.15 conditions; 210.16 (5) access response effects; 210.17 (6) measure and account for respondent inaccuracy in 210.18 behavior reports; 210.19 (7) assess validity and reliability of methods and evaluate 210.20 credibility of sources; 210.21 (8) look for pattern and meaning in data; 210.22 (9) analyze field notes; and 210.23 (10) communicate research findings. 210.24 ARTICLE 18 210.25 WORLD LANGUAGES 210.26 Section 1. [WORLD LANGUAGES - PRIMARY.] 210.27 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Gain exposure to a language 210.28 other than English. 210.29 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 210.30 understanding of: 210.31 (1) basic features of the language, including vocabulary, 210.32 syntax, and grammar necessary for communicating about very 210.33 familiar topics; 210.34 (2) some age-appropriate cultural practices and products 210.35 (for example, gestures, songs, and games); and 210.36 (3) basic similarities between some written and spoken or 211.1 signed words of the target language and English. 211.2 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 211.3 to: 211.4 (1) participate in brief written and oral exchanges or 211.5 signed conversations with guidance on familiar topics; 211.6 (2) comprehend basic written and spoken words and phrases 211.7 or signed words, classifiers, and phrases that are supported by 211.8 context clues and repetition; and 211.9 (3) present basic written and oral or signed personal 211.10 information using very common words and memorized phrases. 211.11 Sec. 2. [TECHNICAL LANGUAGE - PRIMARY.] 211.12 Subdivision 1. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 211.13 understanding of: 211.14 (1) the concept that letters, characters, icons, signs, and 211.15 symbols represent ideas, quantities, elements, and actions; and 211.16 (2) the purpose of the message (for example, to perform a 211.17 computer action, to produce a product, or to describe a person's 211.18 health). 211.19 Subd. 2. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 211.20 to read and explain basic symbolic and technical representations. 211.21 Sec. 3. [WORLD LANGUAGES - INTERMEDIATE.] 211.22 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Explore and begin to communicate 211.23 in a language other than English. 211.24 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 211.25 understanding of: 211.26 (1) basic features of the language, including vocabulary, 211.27 syntax, and grammar necessary for communicating about familiar 211.28 and personal topics; 211.29 (2) some common, age-appropriate cultural practices, 211.30 traditions, and expressive products (for example, greetings, 211.31 songs, stories, and games); and 211.32 (3) some similarities and differences between the target 211.33 language and English (for example, commonly occurring cognates 211.34 and borrowed words, pronunciation, intonation, sentence 211.35 structure, and alphabet/characters/signs). 211.36 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 212.1 to: 212.2 (1) participate in written and oral exchanges or signed 212.3 conversations on familiar and personal topics; 212.4 (2) comprehend basic written and spoken or signed language 212.5 about familiar topics and in familiar contexts; 212.6 (3) present basic written and oral or signed information 212.7 about familiar topics using memorized and familiar words and 212.8 simple phrases and sentences; and 212.9 (4) use culturally appropriate practices (for example, 212.10 greetings and gestures) in a limited number of familiar 212.11 situations. 212.12 Sec. 4. [TECHNICAL LANGUAGE - INTERMEDIATE.] 212.13 Subdivision 1. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 212.14 understanding of: 212.15 (1) common letters, characters, icons, signs, and symbols 212.16 that represent ideas, quantities, elements, and actions; and 212.17 (2) the audience and purpose of the message. 212.18 Subd. 2. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 212.19 to read and apply symbolic and technical representations, with 212.20 guidance, to perform an action or create a basic product (for 212.21 example, a group Web page, a plan for constructing a box, a 212.22 carton, or a toy). 212.23 Sec. 5. [WORLD LANGUAGES - MIDDLE.] 212.24 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Communicate in a language other 212.25 than English on familiar topics in cultural contexts, as 212.26 appropriate. 212.27 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 212.28 understanding of: 212.29 (1) features of the language, including vocabulary, syntax, 212.30 and grammar necessary for communicating about a variety of 212.31 common topics; 212.32 (2) a range of common cultural practices and products (for 212.33 example, food, clothing, dwellings, music, and artifacts); and 212.34 (3) similarities and differences between the target 212.35 language and English, including idioms, sentence structure, 212.36 cognates, and false cognates. 213.1 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 213.2 to: 213.3 (1) initiate and respond to written and oral exchanges or 213.4 signed conversations to express needs, limited options, and 213.5 experiences using learned material about familiar topics; 213.6 (2) comprehend written and spoken or signed language 213.7 relating to daily living and common events in formal and 213.8 informal situations; 213.9 (3) create and deliver written and spoken or signed 213.10 presentations about familiar topics using simple phrases and 213.11 expressions; and 213.12 (4) communicate in familiar situations using appropriate 213.13 cultural practices (for example, formal and informal register, 213.14 personal space, and manners). 213.15 Sec. 6. [TECHNICAL LANGUAGE - MIDDLE.] 213.16 Subdivision 1. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 213.17 understanding of: 213.18 (1) the basic features and symbols of a technical language; 213.19 and 213.20 (2) the audience, purpose, medium, and nature of the 213.21 message. 213.22 Subd. 2. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 213.23 to: 213.24 (1) read and explain symbolic and technical 213.25 representations; and 213.26 (2) create a plan or product using the technical language 213.27 (for example, a piece of furniture, the floor plan of the 213.28 student's residence) or html programming for a Web page. 213.29 Sec. 7. [NATURE OF LANGUAGE AND CULTURE - HIGH SCHOOL.] 213.30 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Communicate in a language other 213.31 than English on a variety of topics and understand how language 213.32 and culture are interconnected. 213.33 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 213.34 understanding of: 213.35 (1) features of the target language, including vocabulary, 213.36 syntax, and grammar necessary for communicating about a variety 214.1 of topics; 214.2 (2) culture: 214.3 (i) common patterns of behavior and practices of typical 214.4 peers and others in the target culture; and 214.5 (ii) products and perspectives of the target culture (for 214.6 example, people of importance, print and nonprint cultural 214.7 artifacts, and commonly held attitudes and ideas; 214.8 (3) similarities and differences in the ways languages are 214.9 written and spoken or signed (for example, writing mechanics, 214.10 sentence structure, intonation, and word stress); and 214.11 (4) how language and cultural practices, products, and 214.12 perspectives are interrelated. 214.13 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 214.14 to: 214.15 (1) initiate and respond to written and oral exchanges or 214.16 signed conversations that reflect structural patterns of the 214.17 language in familiar and practiced situations; 214.18 (2) comprehend written and spoken or signed language about 214.19 a variety of familiar topics that reflect cultural practices, 214.20 products, and perspectives; 214.21 (3) create and deliver written and spoken or signed 214.22 presentations about a variety of familiar topics using a range 214.23 of simple phrases and expressions; and 214.24 (4) communicate in a variety of familiar situations using 214.25 appropriate cultural practices (for example, formal and informal 214.26 register, personal space, and manners). 214.27 Sec. 8. [COMMUNICATING IN A LANGUAGE OTHER THAN ENGLISH - 214.28 HIGH SCHOOL.] 214.29 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Comprehend and communicate in a 214.30 language other than English on a broad range of topics. 214.31 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 214.32 understanding of: 214.33 (1) features of the language, including vocabulary, syntax, 214.34 and sociolinguistic, lexical, and grammatical systems necessary 214.35 for communicating about a wide range of personal and general 214.36 topics; 215.1 (2) similarities and differences in cultural products, 215.2 practices, and perspectives between the target culture and the 215.3 student's own; and 215.4 (3) similarities and differences between the sound or 215.5 signed and written systems of the target language and English, 215.6 including regional and national spoken or signed patterns and 215.7 familiar genres of written texts (for example, poems, letters, 215.8 newspapers, and magazine articles). 215.9 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 215.10 to: 215.11 (1) initiate, sustain, and close written and oral exchanges 215.12 or signed conversations in a variety of familiar and new 215.13 situations; 215.14 (2) comprehend the main idea and supporting details of 215.15 written and spoken or signed language from a variety of 215.16 authentic sources that are produced for various audiences and 215.17 purposes; 215.18 (3) present or perform both student-created and culturally 215.19 authentic texts (for example, essays, poetry, plays, stories, 215.20 songs, and letters); and 215.21 (4) communicate in formal and informal situations using a 215.22 wide range of appropriate cultural practices and expressions. 215.23 Sec. 9. [COMMUNICATING IN A TECHNICAL LANGUAGE - HIGH 215.24 SCHOOL.] 215.25 Subdivision 1. [PURPOSE.] Comprehend and communicate using 215.26 a universal technical language. 215.27 Subd. 2. [PART A.] A student shall demonstrate an 215.28 understanding of: 215.29 (1) the features, symbols, and appropriate applications of 215.30 a symbolic and technical language; 215.31 (2) relevant technical vocabulary; and 215.32 (3) design considerations pertinent to the products or 215.33 services to be delivered (for example, building codes or Web 215.34 browser limitations). 215.35 Subd. 3. [PART B.] A student shall demonstrate the ability 215.36 to: 216.1 (1) read, comprehend, and analyze complex symbolic and 216.2 technical representations (for example, documents, plans, or 216.3 drawings); and 216.4 (2) apply a symbolic and technical language to communicate 216.5 how to perform a complex action or produce a complex product 216.6 (for example, a complete set of plans for a single-family 216.7 residence) or html programming of a complete Web site.